Advanced Accounting
Advanced Accounting
Advanced Accounting
directors)
Capital
Interest , dividend
Tax
The value added statement measures performance in terms of value added by the
enterprise through the collective efforts of management, employees and the providers of
capital. The statement shows how value added has been (i) distributed to those
contributing to its creation and the government and (ii) reinvested in the business.
Value-added is the accounting synonym for Wealth creation. Thus it reflects wealth
creation and wealth distribution. This translates into two very powerful and mutually
supporting strategic "legs": maximum wealth creation and sensible distribution. In turn
five strategic principles are involved here. Three of them relate to wealth creation and
two to distribution. Optimum wealth creation is the result of (1) selling the most you can;
(2) getting the best price; and (3) keeping your outside costs as low as possible. Sensible
distribution is based on (4) meeting the legitimate expectations of each stakeholder and (5)
encouraging continued contribution.
Value-added is the companys contribution to GDP, and therefore a contribution to
national prosperity. It is the companys contribution to the market and society as a whole.
It is the golden thread that binds capital, labour, management and government all together.
2
Reinvestment
VAS is prepared on the lines of Income statement ( i.e. Profit and Loss Account ).
While preparing this statement ( on the lines of the Income statement ), the
above four categories the items are not considered in the statement (VAS) .
There are two types of value added statements (a) Net Value Added
Statement and (b) Gross value Added Statement. The Statement, that
we have referred above, is Gross VAS. In Net VAS, depreciation is
considered as a part of VAS itself and not shown in distribution
statement. If the question is silent regarding net or gross, we may
prepare Gross VAS as it is on the lines suggested by CIMA, London.
(ii)
(iii)
There are two opinions regarding treatment of Excise and sales tax
while preparing the value added statements. As per first opinion , these
should be considered while preparing the Value Added Statement. The
second opinion is to show their amount should be shown in the
distribution statement under the head Government . The first approach
is more popular with the professional, the second is favoured by the
academicians.(We may follow the first approach )
Question No. 1
The following figures for a period were called out from the books of
Corporation:
Rs.
Sales
24,80,000
10,00,000
Agents commission
20,000
Consumable stores
25,000
Packing material
10,000
Stationery
10,000
Audit Fees
4,000
1,58,000
Insurance
26,000
16,000
84,000
Traveling expenses
21,000
9,000
Electricity
5,000
24,000
10,000
Advertisement
25,000
6,30,000
Value
4
Postage and telegrams
14,000
60,000
40,000
Subscription paid
2,000
Carriage
22,000
18,000
Dividend to shareholders
30,000
Depreciation provided
55,000
Income-tax provided
1,00,000
Retained earnings
1,25,000
85,000
Finished goods
2,00,000
1,08,000
Finished goods
2,40,000
From the above you are required to prepare a statement detailing the source
and disposal to added value. Does your statement corroborate the assertion of
the chairman of the company in the annual general meeting that 75 per cent of
added value is accounted by employee costs?
Ans.
Sales
Increase in F. Stock
Raw material consumed
Agents commission
Con. Stores
Packing material
Stationary
Audit fees
Insurance
Rent
24,80,000
40,000
25,20,000
9,77,000
20,000
25,000
10,000
10,000
4,000
26,000
16,000
5
T. Exp.
Fuel & Oil
Elec.
Mat. Used in repairs
Advertisements
Postage
Subscription paid
Carriage
21,000
9,000
5,000
34,000
25,000
14,000
2,000
22,000
12,20,000
13,00,000
Value added
Amount
9,72,000
74.77
1,00,000
7.69
48,000
3.69
1,80,000
13.85
13,00,000
100
1,58,000
84,000
6,30,000
Cont. PF
60,000
D. Fees
40,000
Government
Taxes
Capital
Dividend
30,000
Int.
18,000
Reinvestment
Dep.
55,000
Retained earnings
1,25,000
Total
6
Question No. 2:Worthwhile Corporation had been preparing value added
statements for the past five years. The personnel manager of the company has
suggested that a value added incentive scheme when introduced will motivate
employees to better performance. To introduce the scheme, it is proposed that
the best index performance, i.e., employee costs to added value for the last 5
years will be used as the target index for future calculations of the bonus to be
earned.
After the target index is determined, any actual improvement in the index will
be rewarded, the employer and employees sharing any such bonus in the ratio
1 : 2. The bonus is given at the year-end, after profit for the year is determined.
From the following details, find out the bonus to be paid to the employees, if any,
for 1987 :
Value Added Statement for 5 years (Rs.000)
Year
1982
1983
1984
1985
1986
Sales
2,800
3,800
4,600
5,200
6,000
1,280
2,000
2,500
2,800
3,200
1,520
1,800
2,100
2,400
2,800
Employees costs
650
760
840
984
1,120
Dividend
100
150
200
240
300
Taxes
320
380
420
500
560
Depreciation
260
310
360
440
560
Debenture interest
40
40
40
40
40
Retained earnings
150
160
250
196
200
1,520
1,800
2,100
2,400
2,800
Less: Bought in
good service
Added value
Added value
7
Summarized P&L for 1987 (Rs.000)
Sales
7,300
Cost of material
2,500
Wages
700
Prod. salaries
200
Prod. expenses
700
Dep. of Machines
500
Adm. Salaries
300
Adm. Expenses
300
Adm. Depreciation
200
Deb. Interest
40
60
Sales Expenses
200
60
5,760
Profit
1,540
Ans.
1982
Index performance
1983
1984
1985
1986
650
760
840
984
1120
1520
1800
2100
2400
2800
= .40
= .41
= .40
= .43
= .42
7300
2500
P. Exp.
700
A. Exp.
300
S. Exp.
200
3700
8
Value added
3600
: 1260
Total Bonus
: 180
Bonus to employees
: 120
Bonus to employers
Distribution of VA
60
Employees
Wages
700
Production salaries
200
Adm. Salaries
300
Sales salaries
60
Bonus
120
1380
38.33
100
2.78
Capital
Bonus to employer
(assumed by way of dividend)
Interest
60
40
Reinvestment
Retained profit
Dep.
1360
760
Total
2120
3600
58.89
100.00
9
Q. No. 3 : S.V. Ltd. have announced Xmas bonus for staff 50 per cent of
any value added earned in excess of $1.35 per $1 of labour. S.V. Ltd.s results
for year ended 30th September, 1990 are as follows : ($000)
Sales
5,000
Cost of Sales
Cost of production:
Materials
1,000
Direct labour
1,200
Factory overhead*
1,500
3,700
Work-in-progress :
Opening
140
Closing
160
(20)
400
Closing
440
(40)
Gross profit
3,640
1.360
S.& A. Overhead*
870
------
Trading profit
490
Royalties received
10
Net profit
500
Taxation
200
300
Dividends
100
Profit
200
10
Factory
*Overhead analysis($000)
Wages and salaries
400
470
Equipment leasing
50
10
200
50
Depreciation
340
Find the amount of bonus due to an employee whose wages is $ 5000 p.a.
Ans.
Sales
5000
Increase in F. Stock
40
Increase in WIP
20
Material
1000
FO 50 + 850
900
SAO 10+340
350
VA by manufacturing activities
VA by other activities
TOTAL VA
2250
2810
10
2820
Bonus to staff
5060
11
Distribution of VA
%
Employees
2082.75
73.86
Capital (Div.)
100.00
3.55
Govt. ( Tax)
200.00
7.09
437.25
15.50
2820.00
100.00
Total
Q.NO.4 The following is the Profit & Loss account of Galaxy Ltd. for the year
ended 31.3.04. Prepare Gross value added statement and show the
reconciliation between GVA and Profit Before Tax :
Profit and Loss account for year ended 31.3.2004 (Rs. Lakhs )
Income:
Sales
890
Other income
55
945
Expenditure:
Production and operational expenses ( note a)
641
33
Interest
(note c )
Dep.
29
17
720
PBT
225
Tax (note d )
30
PAT
195
10
205
45
Dividend
95
140
12
Surplus carried to B/S
65
293
Stores
59
82
98
109
641
10
Interest on debentures
2
29
(d) The charges for taxation include a transfer of Rs.3.00 to the credit of deferred
Tax Account
(e) Cess and Local taxes include excise duty, which is equal to 10 % of cost of
raw material bought in .
Ans.
Sales
890.00
Less excise
-29.30
Net sales
860.70
293.00
59.00
109.00
461.00
13
Factory exp ( Admi. )
24.00
Interest of w. c. borrowings
9.00
494.00
366.70
Other incomes
55.00
Total VA
421.70
Distribution statement
%
Employees (82 + 9 )
91.00
21.58
95.70
22.69
115.00
27.27
Tax)
120.00
28.46
Total
421.70
100.00
225.00
91.00
68.70
Interest
20.00
Dep.
17.00
Vale Added
421.70
14
Q.NO. 5
Ltd., you are required to prepare (a) Gross VAS (b) reconciliation of Gross VA
with PBT
PROFIT AND LOSS A/C OF BRITE LTD. FOR YEAR ENDED 31.3.2003
(Rs.000)
Income
Sales
15,27,956
130
Misc. Income
474
Total
15,28,560
Expenditure
Production and operational expenses
Decrease in inventory of finished goods 26,054
Consumption of raw material
7,40,821
Power
1,20,030
Wages
3,81,760
26,240
Excise duty
14,540
32,565
13,42,010
7,810
Other Administrative
32,640
40,450
Interest on debentures
14,400
10,000
100
50,600
1457560
PBT
71000
Dep.
15
Tax
25,470
PAT
45530
6300
51,830
Transferred to GR 18,212
Dividend
22,000
Tax on dividend
2,818
43,030
Ans.
8800
15,13,416
Decrease in F. Stock
- 26,054
14,87,362
Mat.
7,40.821
Power
1,20,030
32,565
32,640
Int. on BO
100
9,26,156
VA by Manu. activities
5,61,206
604
5,61,810
Distribution statement
%
Employees & Management :
Wages
Staff welfare exp.
Director remuneration
381760
26240
7810
4,15,819
74.01
16
Govt.
Income tax
25470
Dist, tax
2818
28,288
5.04
Capital
Int. Deb.
14400
Int. loan
10000
DIV.
22000
46400
8.26
Reinvestment
Retained profit
GR
Dep
2500
18212
50600
Total
71312
12.69
561810
100.00
Reconciliation :
PBT
71000
Wages
381760
Staff
26240
D. Remuneration
7810
Int. Deb.
14400
Int. Loan
10000
Dep
50600
Value added
561810
Q. No. 6 From the following Profit and Loss Account of Kalyani Ltd., prepare
Gross value added statement. Show also the reconciliation of Gross Value
Added and Profit before Taxation :
Profit and Loss Account for the year ended 31st March, 1995 : ( Amounts in Rs.
Lakhs) :
Sales
Other income
Income
206.42
10.20
216.62
17
Expenditure
Production and operational exp.(note 1 )
166.57
6.12
8.00
Dep.
5.69
30.24
186.38
PBT
Taxes
3.00
PAT
27.24
0.46
1.35
29.05
- 24.30
Proposed Dividend
- 3.00
1.75
30.50
Consumption of material
80.57
Consumption of stores
5.30
12.80
3.20
34.20
Total
166.57
(2) Administrative expenses include inter-alia Audit fees of Rs. 1 Lakh, Salaries
to Directors Rs.2.20 Lakhs and Provision for doubtful debts Rs. 2.50 Lakhs.
(3) Interest and other charges Rs. Lakhs
Int. on fixed loans from financial institution
3.90
Interest on debentures
1.80
2.30
Total
8.00
Ans.
18
Sales
206.42
Decrease in stock
-30.50
175.92
80.57
Stores
5.30
34.20
Audit fees
1.00
2.50
0,42
2.30
126.29
49.63
VA by other incomes
10.20
Total VA
59.83
Distribution statement
Rs.
Rs.
12.80
2.20
15.00
25.07
8.70
14.54
6.20
10.36
Capital
Interest on fixed loans
3.90
Interest on debentures
1.80
Dividend
3.00
Government
Cess and local taxes
3.20
Income tax
3.00
Reinvestment
Dep.
5.69
Increase in P & L
0.40
GR
24.30
19
Invest, allowance written back
Total
-0.46
29.93
50.03
59.83
Reconciliation of PBT with Gross VA
PBT
Salaries
Salaries and com.
Int. on deb.
Int. on fixed loans
Cess and local tax
Dep.
Gross VA
100
30.24
12.80
2.20
1.80
3,90
3.20
5.69
59.83
Q. No. 7 : From the following Profit & Loss A/c , prepare a Gross value added
statement for the year ended 31.12.98. Show also the reconciliation between
GVA and PBT.
Profit and Loss A/c for the year ended 31.12.98 (Rs.000)
Income
Sales
6240
Other income
55
6,295
Expenditure
Production and operational exp.(note 1 )
4320
180
624
Dep.
1,155
16
5,140
Taxes
PAT
55
1,100
+60
1,160
PBT
- 400
- 160
600
20
Notes (1) Production and operational expenses ( Rs. thousands)
Consumption of raw materials
3210
Consumption of stores
40
Local taxes
Salaries
620
442
Total
4320
109
51
20
Ans.
Distribution statement
Rs.
Rs.
620
Salaries to directors
625
33.69
51
Dividend
160
211
11.37
63
3.40
Capital
Government
Local taxes
Income tax
55
Reinvestment
21
Dep.
16
Increase in P & L
540
Replacement reserve
400
Total VA
VA by other activities
956
51.54
1855
100
55
1800
6240
-180
3210
Stores
6060
40
442
175
624
Less excise
-180
-51
393
4260
1800
VA by other incomes
55
Total VA
1855
Reconciliation of PBT with Gross VA
PBT
Salaries
Salaries and com.
Int. on fixed loans
Local tax
Dep.
1155
620
5
51
8
16
Gross VA
1855
Q. No. 8 From the following Profit & Loss A/c , prepare a Gross value added
statement . Show also the reconciliation between GVA and PBT.
22
Profit and Loss A/c for the year ended 31.3.2002 (Rs.lakhs)
Income
Sales
800
Other income
50
850
Expenditure
Production and operational exp.
600
Administration expenses
30
30
Dep.
170
20
680
PBT
Taxes
30
PAT
140
10
150
- 80
Proposed Dividend
- 20
50
320
60
Cess
20
200
Total
600
Administrative Expenses:
Audit fees
Salaries to directors
Other exp.
10
Total
30
23
Interest and other charges :
On working capital loans
10
15
On debentures
Total
30
Example: C.E. Rs.1000 crores. Debt Equity Ratio 0.20:0.80. Debt carries 15%
interest, Tax 35%, cost of equity 18%, EBIT Rs.300 crores. EVA?
Answer:
Cost of debt = 15x.65 =9.75%
Weighted average cost of equity and borrowed funds. It is calculated on the basis of current cost and not
on the bass of historical cost.
3
Net operating profit = EBIT Tax on EBIT
24
Example (ii) calculate EVA : Financial leverage 1.40 times, cost of equity 17.50%
Income tax rate 30% Capital Structure : (i) equity capital Rs.170 lakhs (ii)
Retained earnings Rs.130 lakhs &(iii) 10% debentures Rs.400 Lakhs.
---------------------EBIT 40
Cost (X)
Equity
17.50
Debe.
7.00
Weight(W) XW
300
5250
400
2800
700
8050
Calculation of EVA :
EBIT
140
!
Tax on EBIT
-42
98
-80.50
17.50
25
The capital charge is the most distinctive and important aspect of EVA. The
capital charge in EVA is what economists call an opportunity cost. It is the return
that investors could expect to get by putting their money in a portfolio of other
shares and debentures of comparable risk. The concept dates all the way to
Adam Smith who opined that for its survival ,a business has to provide a
minimum competitive return on all the capital invested in it. The cost of capital, or
required rate of return, or capital charge ( by whatever name we may refer it ),
applies to equity as well as debt.
WACC : WACC is the weighted average cost of debt, cost of preference shares
and cost of equity shares, weights being market values of debt, preference
shares and equity shares.
In determining WACC, cost of debt is taken as after-tax, cost of preference
shares is calculated before tax saving ( as preference dividend is not tax
deductible) and cost of equity shares is estimated on the basis of Capital Assets
Pricing Model (CAPM)
26
reporting the profit towards the lower side). A few important adjustments to
accounting operating profit are as follows:
(i)
(ii)
(iii)
(i)
(ii)
(iii)
Get rid of those parts of business that earn less than WACC.
(iv)
(ii)
(i)
(ii)
(iii)
27
EVA & Incentive Compensation
The objective of incentive compensation is to make managers behave like
owners. They should identify themselves with the fortunes of the company.
EVA is a useful tool for incentive compensation. When the bonus of
managers is linked to increase in EVA, they think and act like owners. They
do, all that they can, to improve EVA.
28
Market value of a company depends upon its EVA. There is high
degree of correlation between EVA growth and market value addition.
Increase in EVA results in increase of market value and vice- versa.
Conclusion
The most valuable resource in any company is the creativity and will to
succeed that its people possess. EVA equips them with better information
and better motivation to succeed.
2001
Turnover
326
380
67
84
Tax
23
29
44
55
DIVIDENDS
15
18
RETAINED PROFIT
29
37
2001
FA
120
156
Net CA
130
160
250
316
29
Equity shareholders fund
195
236
Debt
55
80
250
316
Other Information : (i) The companys pre-tax cost of debt was estimated to be
9% in 2000 and 10% in 2001. (ii) The companys cost of equity was estimated to
be 15% in 2000 and 17% in 2001. (iii) the tax rate was 35% in both 2000 and
2001. (iv) Interest expense amounted to 4 Million in 2000 and 6 Million in 2001.
Estimate the EVA for each of the two years. Comment upon the performance of
the company. (Adapted ACCA)
ACCOUNTING
The accounting
FOR
Refer to page 18, Suggested Answers of May 2004 exam CA Final I group (published by Board of
Studies, ICAI )
30
be credited to Cancer Research Restricted Revenue Fund Account. In case of
such funds, revenue is recognized to the extent of revenue expanded. For
example, suppose in the first year a sum of Rs. 1,00,00,000 is being spent
towards cancer research; then this amount will be debited to the Cancer
Research Restricted Revenue Fund Account (thus the balance left in Cancer
Research Restricted Revenue Fund Account. will be Rs.4,00,00,000 ) and
credited to Income and Expenditure Account. Unrestricted revenue funds are
used for meeting operating expenses for achieving objects of the organization.
Specific funds ( these funds are of capital nature ) are earmarked for well-defined
purposes. Important specific funds are (i) Endowment fund (ii) Loan funds (iii)
Annuity and Life Income Funds and (iv) Development funds .
Endowment funds are not to be spent currently, income out of these funds is
available for restricted or general purposes. [ For example, Union Budget for the
year 1992-93, created an endowment fund of Rs.5,00,00,000 for Ratan Tata
Library of Delhi School of Economics. This amount is not to be spent by Ratan
Tata Library, income from this amount is to be spent by the Library, year after
year, for purchasing the books and subscribing the journals. In this case, the
income of the endowment fund is to be spent for specific purposes. Suppose the
income of the endowment was available to Delhi School of Economics for any
purpose, then we could have stated that the income of the endowment fund is
available for general use]. Endowment fund may be perpetual or term
endowment. Endowment fund referred above is perpetual endowment , its
corpus amount of Rs.50000000 is never to be used; only its income is to be
used. Had the case been that the Ratan Tata Library was permitted to use the
income earned from the corpus for purchasing the books and subscribing the
journals for ten years , and after that the corpus could be used for constructing
the library building, we would have described the endowment fund as term
31
endowment fund.] In case of Annuity and Life Income funds5, periodic payments
are to be made from the designated funds till they are alive. In case of annuity
fund, a fixed amount is to be paid periodically while in case of life income funds,
payments vary with the income earned.[ For example, a senior citizen transferred
all his wealth to a University on the condition that the University shall be paying
him Rs. 25000 p.m. so long he is alive. It is an example of Annuity Fund . Had
the condition being that the university would pay him, through out his life,
whatever income is earned from the wealth, it would have been a case of Life
Income Fund]. Loan funds account for the resources that may be loaned to the
staff. Development funds are for acquiring fixed assets and for their major repairs
( i.e. capital nature repairs). [Ordinary nature repairs are to maintain the
operating capacity and life of the fixed asset while capital nature repairs increase
the operating capacity and life of the fixed asset. 6 ] Development funds are
debited when fixed assets are completely acquired. [ In this case, the cost of
fixed asset is debited to Development fund account and credited to General Fund
Account.
Refer to page 18, Suggested Answers of NOV 2003 exam CA Final I group (published by Board of
Studies, ICAI )
6
If nothing mentioned in the question, assume the repair to be of revenue nature.
32
expected to account and submit vouchers for this portion of the grant. This
portion of the grant ( Grant towards overheads ) is transferred to the unrestricted
Revenue account. Suppose in the above example, the amount of Rs.20,00,000 is
towards overheads, then the amount of Rs.4,80,00,000 will be credited to
Cancer Research Restricted Revenue Fund Account and Rs.20,00,000 will be
credited to Unrestricted Revenue Fund Account ( this account is also known as
General Fund Account ).
An important point regarding Fund Accounting is that for each fund there is a
separate Bank account.
Example : A university receives two grants one from the Ministry of Human
Resources to be used for Malaria Research. This grant is of Rs.45,00,000 which
includes Rs.300000 to cover indirect expenses incurred in administering the
grant. The second grant is of Rs. 3500000 received from a reputed trust is to be
used to set up a centre to conduct seminars on malaria related matters from time
to time. During the year, it also received Rs. 500000 worth of equipment donated
by a well wisher for malaria Research. During the year 2001-2002, the University
spent Rs.32,25,000 of the government grant and incurred Rs.300000 overhead
expenses. Rs.28,00,000 were spent from the grant received from the trust. Show
Journal entries.
33
loan fund of Rs.1020000 ( Rs.1000000 granted by the UGC and Rs. 20000
matching grant from the Trust).
Sometimes the applicable law/Articles of the association/trust-deed of the not-forprofit-organization provides for
revenue fund ( also known as general fund ) to some specific fund. Such
transfers are known as mandatory transfers. Suppose the trust deed of a trust
running a college provides that the trust shall be transferring 1% of surplus to
loan fund every year, the transfer so
transfer because there is mandate of the Trust deed behind this transfer. The
transfers to specific funds ( from unrestricted funds ) , which are not provided by
the Articles/trust/law but which are decided from time to time by the governing
body/trust /BOD of the organizations, are known as non-mandatory transfers. For
example while approving the accounts a trust, the trustees notice that trust has a
very large amount of surplus ( excess of income over expenditure ) and hence
decides to transfer a portion of it to the Development Fund. The transfer so
made will be referred as non-mandatory transfer as the transfer is not mandated
by any law/trust-deed/Articles of Association.
Noida University
Associated University
Question No.3 Illustration 2 Study Material page 7.8 From the following details
in
Question No. 4
Management
Institute of World
34
Question No.5 Divine Public Health Hospital runs only an intensive care unit. For
this purpose, it has hired a building at a rent of Rs.10,000 per month. The unit
has undertaken to bear the cost of repair and maintenance.
The unit consisted of 50 beds and 5 more beds can be safely accommodated,
when the situation demands at a charge of Rs.5 per bed per day.
During the year 1998-99, it revealed that only for 120 days in the year, the unit
had full capacity of 50 patients per day and for another 80 days, it had on an
average 40 beds only occupied per day. The total hire charges for this extra beds
incurred for the whole year amount to Rs.4000.
Expert doctors from out station were engaged and the fees were paid on the
basis of number of patients attended and time spent by them and on an average
, it worked out to Rs.20,000 per month in 1998-99. The other expenses for the
year were as under :
Permanent staff:
4 Supervisors, each at a salary of Rs.500 per month
8 nurses, each at a salary of Rs.300 per month
4 ward boys each at a salary of Rs.150 per month
Repairs and Maintenance Rs.7200
Cost of food supplied to patients RS.88000
Laundry charges Rs.56000
Medicine Supplied Rs. 70000
Cost of Oxygen X-ray other than directly borne for treatment of patients
Rs.108000
Janitor and other services for them Rs.25000
Administration charges allocated to the unit Rs.99100
The unit has recovered an overall amount of Rs.100 per day on an average from
each patient. The cost of janitor and other services is variable as it is related to
number of patient days.
35
Prepare a Revenue Statement for the year 1998-99 and indicate the profit per
patient day made by the unit. Also workout the number of patients days required
by the unit to break even.
Pass Journal Entries for the next year, if the unit receives(a) donated medicines
and medicinal supplies of Rs.25000 and (b) medicine expenses of Rs.85000 for
the year includes Rs.5000 donated supplies.
36
(ii)
Q.No.1 History Ltd. set up a factory on 1st January, 1980 at a cost of Rs.100
crores financed 50% by debentures, 30% by preference capital and 20% by
equity capital. By 31st December, 1989 the debentures were repaid and
preference shares were redeemed. The net asset value of per rupee of equity
investment made on 1st January 1980 as on 31.12.1989 was Rs. 8 of which 10%
was in fixed assets and the balance 90% was in the net working capital.
On 1st January, 1990 the company made a right issue of equity shares at a
premium of 50% in the ratio of 1:1; it also made a public issue of equity shares at
7
8
37
a premium of 200% to the tune of 80% of equity capital after the right issue. The
entire proceeds of rights and public issue were earmarked for capital
expenditure .
On 31st December, 1998 the net asset value of one rupee of equity capital based
on the position as on 1.1.1990 was Rs.41 of which only 1% was in fixed assets
and the balance was in net working capital.
You are informed that :
(i)
(ii)
Q.No.2 On 31st March, 1988, when the general price index was say, 100,
Forward Ltd purchased fixed assets of Rs. one crore. It had also permanent
working capital of Rs. 40 Lakhs. The entire amount required for purchase and
permanent working capital was financed by 10 % redeemable preference share
capital.
On 31st March, 1998, the company had reserves of 1.75 crores. The general
price index on that day was 200. The written down value of fixed assets was
Rs.10 lakhs and they were sold for Rs.1.50 crores. The proceeds were utilized
for redemption of preference shares.
On the same day ( 31st March, 1998), the company purchased a new factory for
Rs.10 crores. The ratio of permanent working to cost of assets is to be
maintained at 0.4 :1. The company raised the additional funds required by issue
of equity shares. Based on the above information (a) Quantify the amount of
38
equity capital raised and (b) Show the Balance Sheet as on 1.4.98. (15 marks,
May 98)
Turnover
Profit
Depreciation Issued
ended 31st
before dep.
share
Dec.
and tax
capital
Dividend %
1996
16,00,500
2,60,000
26,500
9,00,000
1997
22,01,200
2,61,000
36,700
9,00,000
11
1998
39,00,000
3,98,000
52,000
9,00,000
13
1999
43,00,000
3,81,700
44,700
9,00,000
15
39
2000
39,00,000
4,40,900
55,300
9,00,000
18
Rs.
Rs.
2,10,000
2,90,000
1,30,000
1,60,000
3,70,000
Current Assets
Stock (at the lower rate of cost
(or net realizable value)
Debtors
3,80,000
5,00,000
80,000
80,000
10,40,000
1,10,000
9,30,000
13,00,000
3,00,000
12,00,000
2. The stock sheets for 1996 and 1997 had been destroyed, but an assurance
was received from the auditors that stocks had always been properly taken
40
and consistently valued. However, owing to errors, occurring in the cost
records, the stock at 31st December, 2000 was valued at 5 per cent less
than its true value; and furthermore the stock at 31st December, 1999 (Rs.
4,41,000) at 5 per cent more than its true value.
3. On 31.12.2000, freehold land and buildings were professionally valued at
Rs. 4,00,000.
4. The depreciation charge in 1997 included an exceptional write off of Rs.
10,000 in respect of the anticipated obsolescence of some process plant
which obsolescence in the event did not occur. This exceptional write off
was not subsequently written back. Otherwise, depreciation on plant and
machinery was provided throughout at 10 per cent per annum, on cost,
which is considered reasonable in the light of the information available
about the estimated useful life of the plant.
5. In 1998 the company closed down its wholesaling department which had
previously broken even suffering a loss on closure of Rs. 16500. The
turnover of this department amounted to Rs. 80,000 in 1996, Rs. 90,000 in
1997 and Rs. 40,000 in 1998. No fixed assets were employed in this
department.
6. On 1.2.2001 the debentures, which had been issued on the inception of the
company, were redeemed, from the sale of one of the investments. Based
on its sale price, this investment had given a dividend yield of 5 per cent in
2000 and 4 per cent in every earlier year.
7. As from 1st January, 2001 it had been agreed that in addition a directors
fee of Rs. 2,000 would be paid to each of the three directors, but that these
fees should not be deducted in arriving at the basic emoluments.
You are required to prepare the accountants report to be included in
prospects. Ignore taxation.
Tutorial Note
41
Accountants report is to be given in the prospectus in two situations (a) when the
fund raised through the prospectus are to be utilized for buying shares in some
company, so that it would become subsidiary of the company issuing prospectus.
For example, the prospectus is to be issued by X Ltd. The funds raised through
the prospectus would be used for buying 60 per cent shares of Y Ltd. The
accountants report in the prospectus to be issued by X Ltd. would be about Y
Ltd. (b) When the funds raised through the prospectus are to be utilized for
acquiring more than 50 per cent
42
any date between 10th Jan.2005 9th May 2005, both days inclusive, ( i.e. on any
date within last 120 days of the date of the prospectus.
If the company (in which shares would be acquired) or business (in which
interest is to be acquired) is less than 5-year-old, the profit/loss should be given
for all years since establishment.
The reporting accountant may make necessary adjustments in his report about
profit/losses and assets and liabilities.
43
(a) the profits have been reported after rectifying the errors regarding stock
valuation. The stock of 1999 was found over valued by Rs.21000 and that of
2000 was found undervalued by Rs.20000.
(b) The profits have been reported after writing back an unnecessary write off of
Rs. 10000 of plant. The plant was written off in 1997. The profits have been
reported after providing depreciation @ 10 % on Rs.10000 for all the years
beginning 1997.
company was closed down in 1998. Loss on closure was Rs.16500. The profits
have been reported after eliminating the effect of this loss as it wont occur in
future. In earlier years, the department has been breaking even.
(d) On 1.2.2001, 6% debentures of Rs. 100000 were redeemed out of sale
proceeds of investments of the same amount. Income from the investments,
which were sold, had been Rs. 5000 in 2000 and Rs.4000 in each of earlier
years. Profits have been reported after eliminating debenture interest and income
from the investments which were sold.
company would be reduced by Rs. 6000 each year on account of increase in the
Directors remuneration.
Notes to part II
(a) the net assets have been reported after rectifying the errors regarding the
stock valuation.
(b) The net assets have been reported after writing back the unnecessary write
off of plant in 1997 ( Rs.10000) and after providing depreciation on the written
back plant for all the years since 1997.
(c) On 1.2.2001, 6% Debentures of Rs.100000 were redeemed out of sale
proceeds of investments of the same amount. The net assets have been
reported after considering these transactions.
Note from examination point of view ( this type of note is not given in practical
life )
44
It is assumed that the current value of the freehold property has been recorded in
the books of accounts before the date of the prospectus.
45
Though human resource has been of importance for any organization since the
dawn of civilization, it acquired the status of being vitally important only in 20th
century. In todays knowledge-based economy, it is the single most important
resource, the combined value of all other resources is only a small fraction of it.
Companies are making fortunes on the basis of knowledge their talented people
have. Market value of these companies is many times more than their intrinsic
values. Why?
These companies have an asset which does not appear in their Balance-sheets.
This asset is creativity of their people who create wealth for the companies
through their intellect. In todays world, value of any company (whether
knowledge-based or not) depends upon knowledge and dedication its people
posses.
In spite of such an importance, human resource does not appear in the financial
statements. Its information is provided only as a part of internal accounting and
reporting for management purposes. This reduces the importance of accounting
information which is supposed to help present and potential investors and other
users of financial statements for framing a picture about future prospectus of the
company.
46
To overcome the above mentioned limitations efforts have been made , though
breakthrough is yet to be achieved, in last four decades to develop HRA i.e. the
process of identifying and measuring data about human resources and
communicating this information to the interested parties. The development of last
four decades has been in the form of various models of HRA.
MODELS OF HRA
(A) Cost based models
(1) Historical costs model
(2) Replacement cost model
(B) Economic value models
(1)Opportunity cost model
(2)Discounted wages and salaries model
(1) Stochastic model
(2) Group basis valuation model
Historical costs model (Developed by R.Likert and his associates)
In this approach, the actual costs of recruiting, training, placing and developing
the employees of an organization are capitalised and amortized over the
expected period the employee is likely to stay with the organization. If the
employee leaves before this period, unamortized amount should be written of as
loss. The method is quite simple. It is simply extension of concept of proper
matching of cost with revenue. As the costs of recruitment, training, placement
and development provide benefits over a number of years, such costs are not
matched against revenue of the year in which these are incurred, rather such
costs are amortized over their useful life.
47
(3) The model is against the provisions of AS 26
Under this model the investment center managers will bid for the scarce
employees they need to recruit. These scarce employees come from within the
firm.
Suppose Department X is an investment center (i.e. its manager controls not
only its costs and revenue but also takes decisions about investments to be
made in his department). Manager of this department requires an engineer
having specific skills and qualities. This type of engineers are not readily
available for being hired. Mr.A, working in Department Y of this company, has
similar skills and qualities. The manager of Department X will bid for Mr.A.
Suppose Mr.A is likely to serve the firm for ten years and during these years his
48
services will result in annual benefit of Rs.50,000 for department X, then the
highest bid by the manager of Department X will be present value of Rs.50,000
annually for 10 years. Suppose cost of capital is 10%, then this value is
Rs.307230. Accordingly, value of this human resource is Rs.307230.
H&J have suggested that this amount should be included in the capital base of
Department X. Suppose Department X has a capital base of Rs. 20,00,000. and
is expected to earn 12% on this base, i.e. Rs. 2,40,000. If this human resource is
given to Department X, its capital base would be considered ( for measuring the
performance of this department) to be Rs.2307230 and the department shall be
expected to earn 12% on Rs.2307230, i.e.Rs.276868.
The main limitation of the model is discrimination between various
employees and this may lower the morale of the employees.
49
Major Limitations:
(i) Possibility that a person may quit before retirement or death not
considered.
(ii) Possibility of promotion/demotion ignored.
(iii) Estimation of future earnings is very difficult.
(iv) The basic concept of the model is difficult to digest; how can the salaries
and wages payable is asset?
Illustration 3 page 6.32 Study Material
Stochastic model (Developed by Flamholtz)
This model is different from Discounted value of salaries and wages model
in following respects:
(i) Discounted value of salaries and wages model considered the
earnings of employees. Stochastic model considers economic benefits
the firm expects from the employees.
(ii) Stochastic model considers career movement i.e. promotion and
demotion.
(iii)Stochastic
model
considers
the
probability
of
an
employees
50
Position
III
0.90
0.50
0.10
--
--
II
--
0.40
0.80
0.90
0.10
--
--
--
---
0.70
EXIT
0.10
0.10
0.10
0.10
0.20
ANSWER:
Value of human resource: .909[(200000x.90)] +.826[(200000x.50)
+(300000x.40)] + .751[(200000x.10) +(300000x.80)] + .683[(300000x.90)] +
.621[(300000x.10) +(500000x.70)] = Rs.
The limitation of the model is that it is very difficult of estimate its various
parameters like probabilities and expected economic benefits.
CONCLUSION
Todays accountant very well understands the importance of Putting the
people on Balance-sheet, yet as this resource deals with such variables which
are most difficult to measure, no reliable model has been developed so far. It is
51
suggested9 that till the breakthrough is achieved, detailed information including
their talents and achievements(i.e. qualitative aspects of people) may be given
as notes to the financial statements.
MUTUAL FUND
A mutual fund is an organization ( in India this organization must be in the
form of a trust ) that pools the savings of a number of investors - called as unit
holders - who share a common goal. The money thus collected is invested
by the professional fund managers in different types of securities depending
upon the objectives of the scheme. The return/ loss on investment is shared
by the unit holders in proportion to the number of units owned by them.
This suggestion has been made by various accounting experts. It is a controversial suggestion. Most of
HR managers have opposed this suggestion. They apprehends that if implemented, this suggestion will
attract head-hunters and the organization will suffer a lot.
52
(3) Assets management company
(4) Custodian
(5) Registrar
Sponsor may be any person or corporate body that establishes the fund and
registers it with SEBI. The fund must be in the form of a trust. It should be formed
under Indian Trust Act 1882 and registered under Indian Registration Act,1908.
The sponsor appoints Board of trustees of the trust. Alternatively, the sponsor
may appoint a company as trustee and in that case the directors of the trustee
company will constitute the Board of Trustees. Two-third of members of the
Board of Trustees should be independent persons, not elated to the sponsor.
53
market instruments. All mutual fund schemes are variations of these three
asset classes. For example, equity fund schemes invest only in equity shares,
debt fund schemes only in debt funds and money market schemes in only in
money market instruments. The other schemes may invest in 2 or 3 of above
mentioned types of instruments subject to pre-determined limits. For example,
a balanced fund may invest 80% in debt and 20% in equity.
On the basis of their structure, all mutual fund schemes can be divided into 2
categories: (1) Open ended (2) Close ended .
An open ended scheme is one that is available to subscription all
through the year. These schemes do not have a fixed maturity .
Investors can conveniently buy and sell units at net asset value based
price at any time. The key feature of this type of scheme is liquidity.
A close ended scheme has a stipulated maturity period. The fund is
open for subscription for a limited period only. Generally , units of such
schemes are quoted on the stock exchanges. This is the exit route for
those who want to go out and entry route for those who want to invest
after the subscription period is over.
The other types of schemes are (1)Tax saving schemes (2)sector specific
schemes and (3)Index based schemes. Tax saving schemes are meant for those
who want to save income tax under section 80 C of Income tax Act, 1961. Sector
specific schemes invest only in the equity shares of a particular sector i.e. IT fund,
Pharma fund, Fast moving consumer goods Fund etc. Index fund invests their
funds in the equity shares included in an index.
NAV : The net assets value of any MF scheme is the current value of its all
assets net of its liabilities. Division of this amount by number of outstanding units
of the scheme, we get NAV per unit. NAV per unit represents the amount which
the holder of one unit will get if the scheme is dissolved or liquidated ( for this
54
calculation, forced or distress sale is not assumed, moreover the liquidation or
dissolution costs are not considered ). NAV per unit is generally called as NAV
( ignoring the phrase per unit ).
Accrued expenses
55
say 8. The value of equity shares of X Ltd. may be taken as 20x8 i.e.
Rs.160.
(II)
56
(III)
(IV)
(V)
(VI)
(VII)
(VIII) Interest income which has been recognized but not received for a
period of 12 months should be debited to revenue account and in
future no further accrual of such income should be recognized.
Annual Report ( Scheme wise ) The annual report shall contain (i) Report of the Board of Trustees on the operations of the various schemes of
the fund and the fund as a whole during the year and the future outlook of the
fund; (ii) Balance Sheet and Revenue Account (iii) Auditor's Report
(iv) Brief statement of the Board of Trustees on the following aspects, namely:(a) Liabilities and responsibilities of the Trustees
(b) Investment objective of each scheme;
(c) Basis and policy of investment underlying the scheme;
(e) Comments of the Trustees on the performance of the scheme, with full
justification.
Contents of Balance Sheet and Revenue Account :
57
The B/s shall give scheme-wise particulars of assets and liabilities.
(a) Market value of each type of investment , for example equity shares,
preference shares, should be stated separately.
(b) The Balance-sheet shall disclose NAV at the end of accounting year.
(c) Disclose all contingent liabilities.
(d) Provision for doubtful debts, provision for accrued income( which is not
likely leased) etc should be deducted out of respective assets and to be
shown in the liability side.
(e) Movement in unit capital should be stated, for example :
No. of units
Rs. Crores
Balance on 1.4.2004
1,00,00,000
10,00,00,000
50,00,000
5,00,00,000
(20,00,000)
(2,00,00,000)
58
manager, consultant, adviser or rendering corporate advisory service in relation
to such issue management.
To act as a merchant banker in India, one has to get registered with SEBI. Only a
body corporate other than non-banking financial company is eligible to get
registration as merchant banker. The SEBI grants registrations for four
categories of merchant bankers:
(i)
(ii)
(iii)
(iv)
The minimum net worth for acting as merchant banker is given below :
Category I : Rs.5.00 crores
10
59
(d) a statement of financial position.
(2) Every merchant banker shall intimate to the Board the place where the books
of accounts, records and documents are maintained.
(3) every merchant banker shall, after the end of each accounting period furnish
to the Board copies of the balance sheet, profit and loss account and such other
documents for any other preceding five accounting years when required by the
Board.
Submission of Half-yearly results
Every merchant banker shall furnish to the Board half-yearly un-audited
financial results when required by the Board with a view to monitor the
capital adequacy of the merchant banker.
Maintenance of books of account, records and other documents
The merchant banker shall preserve the books of accounts and other
records and documents for a minimum period of five years.
Report on steps taken on Auditor's report
Every merchant banker shall within two months from the date of the
auditors' report take steps to rectify the deficiencies, made out in the auditor's
report.
60
(b) that the provisions of the Act, rules, regulations are being complied with;
(c) to investigate into the complaints received from investors, other merchant
bankers or any other person on any matter having a bearing on the activities of
the merchant banker; and
(d) to investigate suo - moto in the interest of securities business or investors
interest into the affairs of the merchant banker.
Accounting by Stockbrokers
(1) Every stock-broker shall keep and maintain the following books of accounts,
records and documents namely; (a) Register of transactions (Sauda Book); (b) Clients ledger;
(c) General ledger;
(e) Cash book;
(d) Journals;
61
(l) Registers of accounts of sub- brokers;
(2) Every stock-broker shall intimate to the Board the place where the books
of accounts, records and documents are maintained.
(3) Every stock- broker shall, after the close of each accounting period furnish
to the Board if so required as soon as possible but not later than six
months from the close of the said period a copy of the audited balance
sheet and profit and loss account, as at the end of the said accounting
period: Provided that, if it is not possible to furnish the above documents
within the time specified, the stock-broker shall keep the Board informed
of the same together with the reasons for the delay and the period of time
by which such documents would be furnished.
(4) Every stock broker shall preserve the books of account and other records for
a minimum period of five years.
62
(c) to investigate into the complaints received from investors, other stock
brokers, sub-brokers or any other person on any matter having a
bearing on the activities of the stock- brokers; and
(d) to investigate suo-moto, in the interest of securities business or
investors' interest, into the affairs of the stock- broker.
Procedure for inspection
(1) Before undertaking any inspection , the Board shall give a reasonable notice
to the stock- broker for that purpose.
(2) where the Board is satisfied that in the interest of the investors or in public
interest no such notice should be given, it may by an order in writing direct that
the inspection of the affairs of the stock broker be taken up without such notice.
(3) On being empowered by the Board, the inspecting authority shall undertake
the inspection.
Submission of Report to the Board
The inspecting authority shall, as soon as may be possible submit an inspection
report to the Board.
Appointment of Auditor : SEBI may appoint a qualified auditor to investigate into
the books of account or the affairs of the stock-broker:
NBFCs
QUES -1 What is a Non-Banking Financial Company (NBFC)?
ANS -1 A Non-Banking Financial Company (NBFC) is a company registered
under the Companies Act, 1956 and is engaged in the business of loans and
advances, acquisition of shares/stock /bonds/debentures / securities issued by
63
Government or local authority or other securities of like marketable nature,
leasing, hire-purchase, insurance business, chit business but does not include
any institution whose principal business is that of agriculture activity, industrial
activity, sale/purchase/construction of immovable property.
A Residuary non-banking company is also a NBFC. Residuary Non-Banking
Company is a class of NBFC which is a company and has as its principal
business the receiving of deposits. These companies are required to maintain
investments as per directions of RBI, in addition to liquid assets. The functioning
of these companies is different from those of NBFC in terms of deployment of
depositors' funds.
QUES 2. NBFCs are doing functions similar to banks. What is difference
between banks & NBFCs ?
ANS 2. NBFCs are doing functions akin to that of banks, however there are a few
differences:
i.) a NBFC cannot accept demand deposits;
ii.) it is not a part of the payment and settlement system and as such cannot
issue cheques to its customers; and
iii.) deposit insurance facility is not available for NBFC depositors unlike in case
of banks.
iv)
The requirements of Cash Reserve Ratio and Statutory liquidity ratio11 are not
11
Banks have to maintain cash reserve ratio ( it is ratio of cash balance with
RBI to demand and time liabilities, it is decided by RBI from time to time
subject to minimum of 3% and maximum of 20%, currently it is 5%, ) and
Statutory Liquidity ratio ( banks are required to maintain cash or gold or
approved securities the amount of which shall not be less than 25% and not
more than 40 % of demand and time liabilities , currently it is 25 % ) on the basis
of issue price.
64
applicable to the NBFCs.
v)
vi) NBFCs do
not have any ceiling on lending in the stock market, Banks have a ceiling of 5% o
their total exposure .
QUES-3. Is it necessary that every NBFC should be registered with RBI?
ANS 3. In terms of provisions of the RBI Act, 1934, it is mandatory that every
NBFC should be registered with RBI to commence or carry on any business of
non-banking finance company.
However, to obviate dual regulation, certain category of NBFCs which are
regulated by other regulators are exempted from the requirement of registration
with RBI viz. Venture Capital Fund/Merchant Banking companies/Stock broking
companies registered with SEBI, Insurance Company , Nidhi companies as
notified under the Companies Act, 1956, Chit companies or Housing Finance
Companies regulated by National Housing Bank.
QUES 4. What are the different types of NBFCs registered with RBI?
ANS 4. The NBFCs that are registered with RBI are:
i. equipment leasing company;
ii. hire-purchase company;
iii. loan company;
iv. investment company;
The above type of companies may be further classified into those accepting
deposits or those not accepting deposits.
v. Residuary Non-Banking Company.
65
QUES 5. What are the requirements for registration with RBI?
ANS 5. A company incorporated under the Companies Act, 1956 and desirous of
commencing business of non-banking financial institution as defined under
Section 45 I(a) of the RBI Act, 1934 should have a minimum net owned fund of
Rs 25 lakh (raised to Rs 200 lakh w.e.f April 21, 1999). The company is required
to submit its application for registration in the prescribed format alongwith
necessary documents for Banks consideration. The Bank issues Certificate of
Registration after satisfying itself that the conditions regarding registration.
QUES 6. Can all NBFCs accept deposits and what are the requirements for
accepting Public Deposits?
ANS 6. All NBFCs are not entitled to accept public deposits. Only those NBFCs
holding a valid Certificate of Registration with authorisation to accept Public
Deposits can accept/hold public deposits.
QUES 7. What is the rate of interest and period of deposit which NBFCs can
accept?
Presently, the maximum rate of interest a NBFC can offer is 11%. The interest
may be paid or compounded at rests not shorter than monthly rests.
The NBFCs are allowed to accept/renew public deposits for a minimum period of
12 months and maximum period of 60 months. They cannot accept deposits
repayable on demand.
QUES 8. What is deposit and public deposit?
ANS 8. Deposit includes any receipt of money by way of deposit or loan or in
any other form . Public deposit as a deposit excluding the following:
66
amount received from local authority or foreign government or any foreign
citizen/authority/person;
QUES 9. Please explain the terms owned fund and net owned fund in relation
to NBFCs?
ANS 9. Owned Fund means aggregate of the paid-up equity capital and free
reserves as disclosed in the latest balance sheet of the company after deducting
there from accumulated balance of loss, deferred revenue expenditure and other
intangible assets.
The amount of investments of such company in shares of its subsidiaries,
companies in the same group and all other NBFCs and the book value of
debentures, bonds, outstanding loans and advances made to and deposits with
subsidiaries and companies in the same group is arrived at. The amount thus
calculated, to the extent it exceeds 10% of the owned fund, is reduced from the
amount of owned fund to arrive at Net Owned Fund.
67
NBFCs Prudential Norms : RBI has issued certain norms which are to be
followwed by the NBFCs. Important norms have been summarized in the
following paragraphs :
Asset Classification
Every NBFC shall classify its lease/hire purchase assets, loans and advances
and any other forms of credit into the following classes namely,
68
(i) Standard assets;
(ii) Sub-standard assets;
(iii) Doubtful assets; and
(iv) Loss assets.
"Standard asset" means the asset in respect of which, no default in repayment of
principal or payment of interest is perceived and which does not disclose any
problem nor carry more than normal risk attached to the business.
Sub-standard asset" means
a. an asset which has been classified as non-performing asset for a
period not exceeding 18 months12
b. an asset where the terms of the agreement regarding interest and /
or principal have been renegotiated until the expiry of one year of
satisfactory performance under the renegotiated or rescheduled or
restructured terms:
"Doubtful asset" means
i.
a term loan, or
ii.
a lease asset, or
iii.
iv.
v.
12
69
Loss asset" means (a) an asset which has been identified as loss asset by the NBFC or its internal
or external auditor or by the Reserve Bank of India during the inspection of the
NBFC, to the extent it is not written off by the NBFC; and
(b) an asset which is adversely affected by a potential threat of non-recoverability
due to either erosion in the value of security or non availability of security or due
to any fraudulent act or omission on the part of the borrower;
Provisioning requirements
Every NBFC shall, after taking into account the time lag between an account
becoming non-performing make provision against sub-standard assets, doubtful
assets and loss assets as provided hereunder :Loans, advances and other credit facilities including bills purchased and
discounted
(1) The provisioning requirement in respect of loans, advances and other credit
facilities including bills purchased and discounted shall be as under :
(i) Loss Assets The entire asset shall be written off. If the assets are permitted to
remain in the books for any reason, 100% of the outstanding should be provided
for;
(ii) Doubtful Assets (a) 100% provision to the extent to which the advance is not
covered by the realizable value of the security
(b) In addition to item (a) above, depending upon the period for which the asset
has remained doubtful, provision to the extent of 20% to 50% of the secured
70
portion (i.e. estimated realizable value of the outstanding) shall be made on the
following basis : -
Period for which the asset has been considered as doubtful % of provision
Up to one year
20
30
50
16,800
1,340
320
90
30
97
48
Calculate the amount of provision, which must be nmade against the advances.
Income recognition
(1) The income recognition shall be based on recognized accounting principles.
71
(2) Income including interest/discount or any other charges on NPA shall be
recognized only when it is actually realised.
(3) In respect of hire purchase assets, where installments are overdue for more
than 12 months, income shall be recognized only when hire charges are actually
received.
(4) In respect of lease assets, where lease rentals are overdue for more than 12
months, the income shall be recognized only when lease rentals are actually
received.
72
(1) Every NBFC shall separately disclose in its balance sheet the provisions
made ( in respect of sub-standard assets, doubtful assets and loss assets )
without netting them from the income or against the value of assets.
(2) The provisions shall be distinctly indicated under separate heads of accounts
as under :(i) provisions for bad and doubtful debts; and
(ii) provisions for depreciation in investments.
(3) Such provisions for each year shall be debited to the profit and loss account.
Mandatory Registration
(ii)
(iii)
(iv)
(v)
(vi)
(vii)
(viii)
73
(ix)
(x)
(xi)
74
lease finance made to and deposits with subsidiaries and companies in the same group
exceeding, in aggregate, ten per cent of the owned fund;
Owned fund means paid up equity capital, preference shares which are compulsorily
convertible into equity, free reserves, balance in share premium account and capital reserves
representing surplus arising out of sale proceeds of asset, excluding reserves created by
revaluation of asset, as reduced by accumulated loss balance, book value of intangible assets
and deferred revenue expenditure.
Tier-II capital includes the following :(a) preference shares other than those which are compulsorily convertible into equity;
(b) revaluation reserves at discounted rate of fifty five percent;
(c) general provisions and loss reserves to the extent these are not attributable to
actual diminution in value or identifiable potential loss in any specific asset and
are available to meet unexpected losses, to the extent of one and one fourth
percent of risk weighted assets;
(d) hybrid debt capital instruments; and
(e) subordinated debt13.
On Balance-sheet assets
The value of each asset/item requires to be multiplied by the relevant risk weights to arrive at
risk adjusted value of assets. The aggregate shall be taken into account for reckoning the
minimum capital ratio. The risk weighted asset shall be calculated as the weighted aggregate of
funded items as detailed hereunder :
Weighted risk assets - On-Balance Sheet items
Percentage weight
(i) Cash and bank balances including fixed
deposits and certificate of deposits
0
(ii) Investments
(a) Approved securities [Except at (c) below]
(b) Bonds of public sector banks
(c) fixed deposits/certificates of deposits/
bonds of public financial institutions
(d) Shares of all companies and
debentures/bonds/commercial papers of all
13
0
20
100
75
companies and units of all mutual funds
(iii) Current assets
(a) Stock on hire (net book value)
(b) Inter-corporate loans/deposits
(c) Loans and advances fully secured against deposits
held by the company itself
(d) Loans to staff
(e) Other secured loans and advances considered good
(f) Bills purchased/discounted
(g) Others (To be specified)
(iv) Fixed Assets (net of depreciation)
(a) Assets leased out (net book value)
(b) Premises
(c) Furniture & Fixtures
100
100
100
0
0
100
100
100
100
100
100
76
Public Deposits
Bank Borrowings
Commercial papers
Inter-corporate deposit
110.00
95.00
40.00
62.00
units)
CAs (including Cash & Bank
Rs.25)
11.00
100.00
502
Contingent Liabilities : Financial GuaranteesRs.0.55 Cr. Bills discounted Rs.1.95 Crs,
Underwriting obligations Rs. 5.25 Crs.
Answer : Owned Fund = Paid up ESC + R & S ( excluding Revaluation Reserve ) Intangible
asset(goodwill)=45+ 90-35= 100
Q. No.2:Calculate(I)Tier I capital(II)TierII capital (III) Risk weighted assets (IV) Risk Adjusted
value of off-Balance-sheet items(V)Capital adequacy ratio using the data of Q.1.
Answer : (Rs. Crores)
Tier I capital :
Owned Funds
100
Investment in W.O.S In excess of 10% of O.F.
-5 95
Tier II Capital
Revaluation Reserve
6.75
Unsecured Loan ( assuming that it is subordinated debt ) 36.00 42.75 137.75
Calculation of Risk weighted assets : ( Rs. crores)
Book value (Rs.)
Risk Weight %
Adjusted value (Rs.)
Cash and bank
25.00
0
0
Other CAs
75.00
100
75
Investment in shares
of subsidiary
10.00
100
10
Investment in shares
of subsidiary
5.00
0
0
Investment in MFs
11.00
100
11
FA ( Premises and
furniture)
61.00
100
61
Goodwill
35.00
0
0
Assets on lease
280.00
100
280
Total
437
Risk Adjusted value of off-Balance-sheet items (Rs. Crores)
Conversion factor
Risk weight
Risk weighted value
Amt.
Financial guarantees
Rs.0.55 100
100%
Bill discounted
Rs.1.95 100
100%
Underwriting
Rs.5.25
50
100%
Total
Total risk adjusted ( weighted ) Items : 437 + 5.125 = 442.125
Capital adequacy ratio : (137.75 / 442.125)x100 = 31.16
0.550
1.950
2.625
5.125
77
the same 31 shares started in both the exchanges. One can trade futures and
options in market lots only. Market lot of Sensex is 50 units, Sensex option is 100
units, Nifty ( future/option ) is 200 units, ACC shares ( future /option ) 1500
shares, Reliance industries ( future/option) is 600 shares and so on. All futures
and options mature on the last Thursday of the month and are cash settled. At a
time 3 series of futures and options are traded in the market. For example, if one
wants to enter into futures/options in the first week of June2005, he may enter
into contract maturing on last Thursday of June,2005 (this is referred as
same/near month contract) or last Thursday of July,2005 ( this is referred as next
month contract ) or last Thursday of August, 2005 ( this is referred as distant
month contact ). Distant month contracts are not popular.
Currently, in India we have (i) futures as well as options on 46 shares14 and (ii)
index futures as well as options contracts based on the BSEs the flagship Index
- SENSEX available for trading at the Stock Exchange Mumbai. We also have (i)
futures as well as options on 52 shares15 and (ii) index futures as well as
options based on Nifty and CNX-IT indices of the NSE. Each contract expires
on the last Thursday of the expiry month and simultaneously a new contract is
introduced for trading after expiry of a contract. ( In Indian stock markets Index
options are of European type and share options of American type )
OPTIONS : An option is a contract that gives its owner the right (but not the
obligation) to buy or to sell an underlying asset (for example, share of a company,
foreign currency etc.) on or before a given date at a fixed price (this fixed price is
called as Exercise price, it is also called as Strike price).
14
ACC, Bajaj Auto, Bank of Baroda, Bank of India, BHEL, BPCL, Canara Bank, CIPLA,
Dr.Reddy, GAIL, GRASIM, GACL, HCL, Hero Honda, Hindalco, HLL, HPCL, HDFC,
ICICI Bank, IFLEX, IOCL, INFOSIS, ITC, Jet Airways, MTNL, M & M, Maruti, NALCO,
NTPC, OBC. ONGC, Polaris, PNB, Ranbaxy, Reliance Energy, Reliance Industries,
Satyam computers, SCI, SBI, TCS, TISCO, Tata Motors, Tata Power, Tata Tea, UBI and
Wipro.
15
Besides 46 above shares, Andhra Bank, Arvind Mills, BEL, HDFC Bank, IPCL and
Syndicate Bank
78
Call option gives the buyer of the option the right (but not the obligation) to buy a
currency or share.
Put option gives the buyer of the option the right (but not the obligation) to sell a
currency or share.
An option that can be exercised on the specific date.
European option
American
Option: An option that can be exercised on any date up to the expiry date.
Example: A & B enter into a contract under which B pays A Rs. 700 (option
premium or option price) and in return A gives him the right of buying 100 shares
of Reliance on a particular date at Rs. 1000 per share. B may buy 100 shares of
Reliance from A at Rs. 1000 on that particular date (or he may not buy).
Suppose Spot price on that date is below 1000, B wont buy the shares. If it is
1000, he may or may not buy. If the spot price is above Rs. 1000, it is natural that
B will exercise his option i.e. he will buy the shares. In this example, B has
limited his loss to Rs. 700 but there is no limit to his gain. The option referred in
this example is European Call option
There are two parties in an option contract:
1)
Option writer or option seller he gives the option to the other party. In
the above example, A is option writer. He receives the option premium
or option price from the other party. In the above example Rs. 700 is
option premium or option price.
2)
Option owner or option holder he gets the option or the right (but
not the obligation) from the option writer against payment of option
premium or option price. In the above example, B is option owner.
79
At-the-money option: If the option holder does not lose or gain whether he
exercises his option or not, the option is said to be at- the- money. (White solving
questions in the examination, it is assumed that if the option is at the money, it is
not exercised by its owner).
Accounting for options :
Q.No. 1 Kanhai buys two options from Arjun. Both follow calendar year as their
accounting year. Give journal entries in the books of both.
Date
of Type
purchase
of Maturity
option
date
Premium
No,
of Margin
Strike
per unit
units
per unit
price
26.5.2005 Rs.20
200
Rs.160
2300
26.5.2005 Rs.25
200
Rs.170
2310
Mr. Arjun was asked to pay additional margin on @ Rs. 10 per unit on call on
10th May,2005 and Rs. 12 per unit on put on 12th May,2005. Assume the spot
prices on maturity to be (i) Rs. 2200 and (ii) Rs. 2400.
Q.No. 2 Kanhai buys two options from Arjun. Both follow financial year (April
March) as their accounting year. Give journal entries in the books of both.
Date
of Type
purchase
of Maturity
option
date
Premium
No,
of Margin
Strike
per unit
units
per unit
price
26.5.2005 Rs.20
200
Rs.160
2300
26.5.2005 Rs.25
200
Rs.170
2310
Mr. Arjun was asked to pay additional margin on @ Rs. 10 per unit on call on
10th May,2005 and Rs. 12 per unit on put on 12th May,2005.
On 31st March 2005, premium per unit (on nifty call, 26th May 2005 maturity,
maturity price Rs.2300) was Rs.10. The premium per unit (on nifty put, 26th May
2005 maturity, maturity price Rs.2310)
was Rs.12.
80
Assume spot prices on maturity date to be (i) Rs. 2200 (ii) Rs.2400
Q. Mr. Investor buys a stock option of ABC Co. Ltd in July, 2003 with a strike
price on 30.7.2003 of Rs. 250 to be expired on 30.8.2004. the premium is Rs. 20
per unit and the market lot is 100. the margin to be paid is Rs. 120 per unit. Show
the accounting treatment in the books of the buyer when : (i) option is settled by
delivery (ii) option is settled in cash. Spot price on maturity Rs. 260.
81
Corporate Social Resposibility is a commitment to improve the wellbeing of
community through discretionary business practices and contribution of corporate
resources.16 It is defined as operating a business in a manner that meets or
excceds the expectations the society has from the corporate. It is a way of
converting a good company to a great company17.
Social responsibilities of the Corporates :
(i) Earning profits and acquiring financial strength : Corporates are expected to
earn profits and acquire financial strengths by providing the quality goods and
honest services to the society at affordable prices and by operating withing the
legal and moral frame-works, otherwise they will not be in a position to do any
social good.
(ii) Efficient use of resources : The corporates should make effcient use of the
resouces and avoid their wastage, be it financil resources, human resources,
energy resources, natural resources or other resources.
(iii) Products : The corporates should produce the goods and services the
society needs, due care should be taken of the quality. They should not produce
the goods and services which are harmful to the society.
(iv) Environment : Damage to the environment can injure the health and well
being of the members of the society. Hence, the corporates should ensure that
their actions do not cause any damage to the environment. Where, some
nominal damge is unavoidable, corrective steps must be undertaken.
(v) Human resource : Society provide this invaluable resource to the corporates.
It is expected of the corporates that they take due care for economic, social and
psychological wellbeing of not only their employees but also other persons
16
82
providing the services to the company like small contractors. Providing healthy
working environment and taking care of their health is the speical responsibility of
the corporates.
(vi) Community : Providing community services enahnces the image of the
corporates. Providing medical check-ups and health services in the
neighbourhoods, building community centres, running creches, organising
tournments and entertainment events etc. create goodwill among the members of
the community.
Corporates draw a lot from the society. They are expected to deliver a lot to the
society. They are interdependent. The wellbeing of one depends on the wellbeing
of the other.
BENEFITS OF CORPORATE SOCIAL RESPONSIBILITY :
CSR is a business strategy that works. In a world where brand value and
reputation are increasingly seen as a company's most valuable assets, CSR can
build the loyalty and trust that ensure a bright sustainable future. In todays world,
the corporations are becoming increasingly visible. They are not judged on their
results but on their behavior too. By integrating CSR into their businesses as
core value, the Corporates are making a significant contribution to a better
society. CSR can and should govern every aspect of business life. The rewards,
both for the corporation and society at large, are enormous.
The benefits of Corporate Social Responsibility
management
83
reputation
and communities
A license to operate
Increased productivity
84
1.Medical and Hospital facilities
2. Educational facilities
3. Canteen facilities
4. Recreation, entertainment and cultural activities
5. Hosing and township facilities
6.
7.
8.
9.
1.
2.
(A-B)
1.
Taxes to Panchayat/Municipality
2.
Environment Improvements
3.
4.
Generation of Business
Total Social Benefits to Community
B. Social Costs to Community :
Increase in cost of living in the vicinity
85
Net Benefits to community (A-B)
2.
1.
2.
Q. From the following information taken from the books of F Ltd. relating to staff and
community benefits, prepare a statement classifying the various items under the
appropriate heads, required under Corporate Social Reporting : (Rs.)
Environmnetal Improvements
Medical facilities
20,10,000
45,00,000
Training facilities
10,25,000
60,75,000
10,70,000
16,55,000
11,25,000
Extra work put in by staff and officers for the drought relief
18,50,000
86
Leave encashment
52,00,000
21,60,000
14,40,000
25,50,000
18
Here the vesting period is three years. Vesting means getting the right to exercise the option. In
this example, the employee gets the right of exercising the option after three years from the date
of the grant of the option provided he continues in the employment of the company.
19
Suppose the option is granted on 1.1.2003. The employee gets the right of exercising the option
on 1.1.2006. He may exercise the option up to 1.1.2008 i.e. on or after 1.1.2006 and up to
1.1.2008, he may apply to the company to issue him 1000 shares against the payment of Rs. 20
per share. If the exercise period lapses the vested option lapses and no right shall accrue to the
employee thereafter. The employee may exercise all the options vested in him in one stroke or
choose to exercise a number of options within the exercise period.
Upon vesting, the employee gets an unfettered right to apply for the issue of shares . In the event
of an employee resigning from the services of the company or his employment being terminated
for whatever reasons, all unvested options shall expire as on that date, but the employee would
retain all the vested options ( except only when the employment is being terminated for some
misconduct)
87
shares @ Rs. 20 per share.
SEBI Guidelines :
(I )The ESOP shall be approved by the shareholders by a special resolution. The
resolution shall contain terms and conditions of the Plan.
(IV) Board of Directors shall disclose either in the Directors Report or in the
annexure to the Directors Report, the details of the operation of the ESOP.
(V) the Board of Directors shall at each AGM place before the members a
certificate from the auditors of the company that the scheme has been
implemented in accordance with SEBI guidelines and in accordance with the
resolution of the company in general meeting.
Q. A company has its share capital divided into shares of Rs. 10 each. On 1st
April, 2004, it granted 10000 employees stock options at Rs. 40, when the
market price was Rs. 130. The options were to be exercised between 16th Dec.
2004 and 15th March 2005. The employees exercised their options for 9500
88
shares only; the remaining options lapsed. The company closes its books on 31st
March every year. Journalize.
SEBI Guidelines
The ESPP should be approved by the shareholders by a special resolution
which should specify the price of the shares and also the number of
shares to be offered to each employee. The number of shares offered may
be different for different categories of employees.
89
Companies have full freedom to price the shares under an ESPP at any
level.
Shares issued under an ESPP shall be locked in for a period of one year.
However if the ESPP is part of a public issue and the shares are issued to
employees at the same price as in the public issue, the shares shall not be
subject to any lock-in.
The details of the shares issued under the ESPP and the terms and
conditions thereof shall be disclosed in the Directors report or in an
annexure thereto.
Corporate Governance
Corporate governance is commonly referred to as a system by which the corporates
are directed and controlled. It is the process by which the corporates objectives are
established, achieved and monitored. Corporate governance is concerned with the
relationships and responsibilities between the board, management, shareholders and
other relevant stakeholders20 within a legal and regulatory framework. Corporate Governance
20
The principal players of a corporate are the shareholders, management and the board
of directors. Other stakeholders include employees, suppliers, customers, banks and other
lenders, regulators, the environment and the community at large.
90
is to conduct the business of a corporate in such ways that the interest of all its stakeholders
( within regulatory frame-work ) are served.
Corporate governance structure specifies the distribution of rights and responsibilities among
different participants in the corporation, such as, the Board, managers, shareholders and other
stakeholders, and spells out the rules and procedures for making decisions on corporate affairs.
By doing this, it provides the structure through which the corporate objectives are set, and also
provides the means of attaining those objectives and monitoring performance. Corporate
Governance is about promoting corporate fairness21, transparency22 and accountability23.
Good governance contributes to good performance. The objective of good
governance is to promote strong, viable and competitive corporations. Boards of directors are
stewards of the corporations assets and their behaviour should be focused on adding value to
those assets by working with management to build a successful corporation and enhance
shareholder value and to take care of interest of all other stakeholders24. Corporate governance
is the key mechanism through which this trust is maintained across all stakeholders.
A country's economy depends on the drive and efficiency of its Corporates. Thus
the effectiveness with which the corporates are governed determines their competitive position
in the international economic scenario.Corporate governance is a key element in enhancing
investor confidence, promoting competitiveness, and ultimately improving economic growth.
The governance of corporates is more important for world economic growth than the
governance of countries. It is at the top of the international development agenda.
Principles
Commonly accepted principles of corporate governance include:
Rights and equitable treatment of shareholders: Organisations should respect the
rights of shareholders and help them to exercise their rights.
Interests of other stakeholders: Organisations should recognise that they have
legal and other obligations to all legitimate stakeholders.
21
Fairness means that all the stakeholders are treated equvitably and have the opportunity
for redress for violation of their rights.
22
Accountability of the board to shareholders means that the shareholders have the right
to receive information on the financial stewardship of their investment and exercise
power to reward or remove the directors entrusted to run the company.
24
91
Role and responsibilities of the board: The board needs a range of skills and
understanding to be able to deal with various business issues and have the ability
to review and challenge management performance.
Integrity and ethical behaviour: Organisations should develop a code of conduct
for their directors and executives that promotes ethical and responsible decision making.
Disclosure and transparency: Organisations should clarify and make publicly known
the roles and responsibilities of board and management to provide shareholders with a
level of accountability. Disclosure of material matters concerning the organisation should
be timely and balanced to ensure that all stakeholders have access to factual information.
Corporate governance In India :
Corporate governance initiatives in India began in 1998 with the Desirable Code
of Corporate Governance a voluntary code published by the CII. The first formal
regulatory framework for listed companies specifically for corporate governance was
established by the SEBI, February 2000, on the basis of recommendations of the
Kumarmangalam Birla Committee Report. The regulatory framework was later on
revised on the basis of Narain Murthy Committee report. Currently, the listed
companies are required to comply with the following conditions ( popularly known
as clause 49 of the listing agreement) as stipulated by the SEBI.
I Composition of Board
(i) The Board of directors of the company shall have an optimum combination
of executive and non-executive directors with not less than fifty percent of the
board of directors comprising of non-executive directors.
(ii) Where the Chairman of the Board is a non-executive director, at least
one-third of the Board should comprise of independent directors and in case
he is an executive director, at least half of the Board should comprise of
independent directors.
II Audit Committee
(A) Qualified and Independent Audit Committee
(i) A qualified and independent audit committee shall be set up with at least 3
directors as members. Two-thirds of the members of audit committee shall be
independent directors.
(ii) All members of audit committee shall be financially literate and at least one
member shall have accounting or related financial management expertise.
(iii) The Chairman of the Audit Committee shall be an independent director;
(iv)The Chairman of the Audit Committee shall be present at Annual General
Meeting to answer shareholder queries;
(v) The Company Secretary shall act as the secretary to the committee.
92
(B) Meeting of Audit Committee
The audit committee should meet at least four times in a year and not more than four
months shall elapse between two meetings.
(C) Role of Audit Committee
1. Oversight of the companys financial reporting process and the disclosure
of its financial information to ensure that the financial statement is correct,
sufficient and credible.
2. Recommending to the Board, the appointment, re-appointment and, if required,
the replacement or removal of the statutory auditor and the fixation of audit fees.
3. Disclosure of any related party transactions
4. Qualifications in the draft audit report.
5. Reviewing, with the management, the quarterly financial statements before
submission to the board for approval
6. Reviewing, with the management, performance of statutory and internal
auditors, adequacy of the internal control systems.
III Disclosures
(A) Basis of related party transactions
(i) A statement in summary form of transactions with related parties in the ordinary
course of business shall be placed periodically before the audit committee.
(ii) Details of material individual transactions with related parties which are not in
the normal course of business shall be placed before the audit committee.
(iii) Details of material individual transactions with related parties or others, which
are not on an arms length basis should be placed before the audit committee,
together with Managements justification for the same.
(B) Disclosure of Accounting Treatment
Where in the preparation of financial statements, a treatment different from that
prescribed in an Accounting Standard has been followed, the fact shall be disclosed
in the financial statements, together with the managements explanation as to why it
believes such alternative treatment is more representative of the true and fair view of
the underlying business transaction in the Corporate Governance Report.
(C) Board Disclosures Risk management
The company shall lay down procedures to inform Board members about the risk
assessment and minimization procedures.
(D) Proceeds from public issues, rights issues, preferential issues etc.
When money is raised through issuing the shares, the company shall prepare a
statement regarding uses of the funds so raised.. This statement shall be
certified by the statutory auditors of the company.
(E) Remuneration of Directors
(i) All pecuniary relationship or transactions of the non-executive directors vis--vis
the company shall be disclosed in the Annual Report.
(ii) Further the following disclosures on the remuneration of directors shall be
made in the section on the corporate governance of the Annual Report:
(a) All elements of remuneration package of individual directors summarized
under major groups, such as salary, benefits, bonuses, stock options,
pension etc.
93
(b) Details of fixed component and performance linked incentives, along with the
performance criteria.
(c) Service contracts, notice period, severance fees.
(d) Stock option details, if any and whether issued at a discount as well as the
period over which accrued and over which exercisable.
(iii) The company shall publish its criteria of making payments to non-executive
directors in its annual report.
IV. CEO/CFO certification
The CEO and the CFO shall certify to the Board that:
(a) They have reviewed financial statements and the cash flow statement for the
year and that to the best of their knowledge and belief :
(i) these statements do not contain any materially untrue statement or omit any
material fact or contain statements that might be misleading;
(ii) these statements together present a true and fair view of the companys
affairs and are in compliance with existing accounting standards, applicable
laws and regulations.
(b) There are, to the best of their knowledge and belief, no transactions entered
into by the company during the year which are fraudulent, illegal or violative of the
companys code of conduct.
(c) They accept responsibility for establishing and maintaining internal controls.
V. Report on Corporate Governance
(i) There shall be a separate section on Corporate Governance in the Annual
Reports of company, with a detailed compliance report on Corporate
Governance.
(ii) The companies shall submit a quarterly compliance report to the stock
exchanges within 15 days from the close of quarter.
VI. Compliance
The company shall obtain a certificate from either the auditors or practicing
company secretaries regarding compliance of conditions of corporate
governance as stipulated in clause 49 and annex the certificate with the
directors report, which is sent annually to all the shareholders of the company.
The same certificate shall also be sent to the Stock Exchanges along with the
annual report filed by the company.
94
(ii)
(iii)
In Holding Company accounts, the date of acquisition (i.e., the date on which
holding company acquired the shares of subsidiary company) is quite important.
We should know the date on which holding company acquired shares of
subsidiary company. Any profit earned by subsidiary company before this date is
pre-acquisition profit. Any profit earned by subsidiary company after this date is
post-acquisition profit. Suppose holding company acquired 80 per cent shares of
subsidiary company on 1.1.1997, then profits earned by subsidiary company
before 1.1.1997 are referred as pre-acquisition profits.
If Holding Company receives any dividend out of pre-acquisition profits of
subsidiary company, such dividend should be credited to Investments in Shares
of Subsidiary Company Account and not to Profit and Loss Account. For
example, on 1.1.1997. X Ltd. purchased 80 per cent shares of Y Ltd., from Mr.
WYE, who has been holding these shares throughout the year 1996, for
Rs. 5,00,000 (X Ltd. should pass the entry with Rs. 5,00,000, Investment in
shares of Y Ltd. A/c Dr., To Bank A/c). On 20.3.1997, Y Ltd. declared dividend of
Rs. 1,00,000 for 1996. X Ltd. will get dividend of Rs. 80,000. (Though X Ltd. had
not been holding these shares in 1996, Mr. WYE had been holding these shares
in 1996, dividend on these 80 per cent shares would be received by X Ltd.,
because companies pay dividend to the shareholders who hold shares on the
date of declaration of dividend). X Ltd. should credit this dividend to Investment
in Shares of Y Ltd. A/c and not to Profit and Loss A/c. The entries should be
(i) Bank A/c Dr. 80,000, To Dividend A/c 80,000, (ii) Dividend A/c Dr. 80,000, To
Investment in Shares of Y Ltd. A/c 80,000.
Question No. 1
95
A Ltd. purchased 6000 shares of B Ltd., from shareholders of B Ltd. on
1.10.1991 for Rs. 7,00,000. Total issued capital of B Ltd. on that date was 7500
shares of Rs. 100 each. On 1.1.1991 Bs P&L A/c had a credit
balance of Rs. 4,00,000. In November 1991, B Ltd. issued bonus shares in the
ratio of 1 : 3. B Ltd.s profit for 1991 Rs. 1,10,000; 1992 Rs. 70,000; 1993 Rs.
20,000. B Ltd. declared and paid dividend at 9 per cent for 1991; 8 per cent for
1992 and 6 per cent for 1993. In each case, dividend was paid on 20th February
of the following year. On 20th March 1994 A Ltd. sold 1,200 shares of B Ltd. at
Rs. 200 per shares. Give Journal of A.
Tutorial Note
Before attempting this question, we should understand a few points:
(a) We do not pass any entry on receipt of bonus shares because there is no
account which can be credited on receipt of these shares. There are three
rules for credit. None of these rules can be applied on receipt of bonus
shares. As per first rule, we credit the giver, here we cannot credit the
account of the company giving the bonus shares because that company is
not becoming our creditor. As per second rule, credit what goes out.
Nothing goes out on receipt of bonus shares. Hence, this rule cannot be
applied. As per third rule, credit the incomes and gains. Even this rule
cannot be applied because receipt of bonus shares does not constitute
income or gain because income or gain is said to have been earned when
there is increase in wealth. Receipt of bonus shares does not increase the
wealth because theoretically value of share reduces proportionately on issue
of bonus shares. Suppose, a person is holding 100 shares of a company,
market price Rs. 100 per share. Total wealth Rs. 10,000. Now the company
issues bonus shares in the ratio of 1 : 1. Theoretically market price per share
will come down to Rs. 50. He will be holding 200 shares. Total wealth = 200
50 = Rs. 10,000.
96
(b) For that accounting year in which bonus shares are issued, companies have
three options :
(i) Paying full years dividend on bonus shares (for that year).
(ii) Paying pro-rata dividend on bonus shares (for that year).
(iii) Paying no dividend on bonus shares (for that year).
(The resolution of bonus shares should specify the option, the company
would follow).
These options are only for that accounting year in which bonus shares have
been issued. From next accounting year, no such discrimination can be
done. All the shares will rank pari passu from next accounting year.
97
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET
Before preparing Consolidated Balance Sheet, we should make four working
notes about subsidiary company.
(i) Capital Profit : By Capital profit, here, we mean pre-acquisition profit that is still
available, i.e., such profits which were earned by subsidiary company in preacquisition period and which are still available, i.e., available on the date of
Consolidated Balance Sheet. Here we are not guided by nature of profit, i.e.,
whether it is profit of revenue nature or of capital nature, we are guided by the
fact that profit was earned in pre-acquisition period. For example, pre-acquisition
revenue profit is capital profit for this purpose.
98
of acquisition. If cost of share is more than book value, the difference is goodwill
and if cost of shares is less than book value, the difference is capital reserve.
Cost of control can be calculated by either of two methods of calculations:
Method I :
Gross-cost of Shares of subsidiary company ................................
(as held by holding company)
Less :(i) Pre-acquisition dividend received/receivable
(ii) Paid up value of such shares
(iii) Holding companys share in capital
Profit of subsidiary company
If the resultant figure is positive, it is goodwill, if it is negative, it is capital reserve.
Method II :
Gross-cost of shares of subsidiary company
................................
................................
Notes :(i) If Gross Cost less Book Value is positive, it is goodwill, otherwise
capital reserve.
(ii) If proposed dividend by subsidiary company was there on the date of
acquisition, book value should be cum-dividend.
(AS-21 uses the term equity for what we have referred as book value here)
RULES FOR PREPARING CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET
(i) Aggregate all the real assets and all the outside liabilities (secured loans,
unsecured loans, current liabilities and Provisions) of the two companies
except Investment in shares of subsidiary company as appearing in
holding company Balance Sheet. This rule is subject to rule No. 2.
99
(ii) Eliminate inter-company Owings.
(iii) Take share capital only of holding company.
(iv) Calculate cost of control and show as separate item.
(v) Calculate minority interest and show as separate item.
(vi) Create reserve for unrealized amount of profit included in stock at least to
the extent of holding companys Share.
For example, subsidiary company purchased certain goods from outside
world for Rs. 1,00,000. Subsidiary company sold these goods to holding
company for Rs. 1,25,000. These goods are still in the stock of holding
company as on date of Consolidated Balance Sheet In the individual
balance sheet of holding company we can show the stock at Rs. 1,25,000
because it is cost for holding company. In the Consolidated balance sheet,
we cannot show the stock at Rs. 1,25,000 because Consolidated Balance
Sheet is the balance sheet of group as a whole and for group as a whole,
cost is not Rs. 1,25,000. Hence, we should create reserve for profit element
included in stock. In this connection, there are two opinions: (i) create full
Stock Reserve, i.e., Rs. 25,000; (ii) create proportionate Stock Reserve, for
example, if holding company is holding 80 per cent shares of subsidiary
company, create Stock Reserve of Rs. 20,000. The first approach is
recommended by AS-21 ( paragraph 16).
(vii) Take reserve and surplus of holding company. Holding companys share in
post-acquisition profit of subsidiary company should be added to the
appropriate (concerned) account of holding company.
Question No. 2
H Ltd. acquired 80,000 shares of Rs. 10 each is S Ltd. on 1.1.1983. The
summarized balance sheets of H Ltd. and S Ltd. on 30.6.1983 were :
S. capital
25,00,000
10,00,000 Machinery
11,00,000 4,50,000
100
Reserves
P&L A/c
1,30,000
1,50,000
20,000
45,000
Furniture
1,00,000
40,000
Shares in S
8,80,000
-----
80,000
-----
Ltd.
Debentures
------
2,50,000
Debentures
in
S Ltd.
Creditors
B/P
4,00,000
2,00,000
20,000
10,000
Stock
5,20,000
6,50,000
Drs.
1,80,000
2,70,000
B/R
10,000
15,000
2,00,000
2,30,000
Cash
Total
30,70,000
16,55,000 Total
30,70,000 16,55,000
B/R of S Ltd. include bills for Rs. 7,000 accepted by H Ltd. and Creditors of S
Ltd. include Rs. 20,000 due to H Ltd. Stock of H Ltd. includes goods of Rs.
10,000 purchased from S Ltd. which made a profit of Rs. 2,000 on these goods.
The balance in the P&L A/c of S Ltd. was nil on 1.7.1982. An amount of Rs.
50,000 was transferred by S Ltd. to reserves during the year. Prepare
consolidated balance sheet. ( Minority Interest Rs.239000
Capital Reserve
Question No. 3
A Ltd. acquired 60 per cent of equity and 80 per cent of preference share in B
Ltd. on 1.1.1983 at a total cost of Rs. 5,00,000. The balance sheets on 31st
December 1983 when the accounts of both the companies were prepared were
as follows :
101
8,50,000
75,000
6,15,000
Plant
2,60,000
Gen. Reserve
(1.1.1983)
P&L
Total
5,15,000
Debtors
4,00,000
1,30,000
Stock
1,70,000
Investment (Shares of B)
5,00,000
Bank
1,65,000
18,40,000
18,40,000
Creditors of A Ltd. include Rs. 60,000 for purchases from B Ltd. on which B
Ltd. made a profit of Rs. 17,500. Stock of A Ltd. includes Rs. 15,000 stock (at
cost to A Ltd.) purchased from B Ltd., part of above-mentioned Rs. 60,000
purchases.
Balance Sheet of B Ltd. (31.12.83)
Equity Capital
1,50,000
6% Pref. Capital
1,00,000
Creditors
80,500
Stock
1,50,500
1,35,000
1,01,000
General Reserve
(1.1.83)
5,000Debtors
P&L A/c
1,85,000
Total
5,20,500
79,000
Bank
55,000
5,20,500
The balance of P&L A/c on 1.1.1983 was Rs. 1,80,000 out of which equity
dividend (at the rate of 16%) and preference dividend were paid for 1982.
102
Prepare consolidated balance sheet as on 31.12.1983. ( Goodwill 217800
M.
20,000
The profits appropriation account, for the years ended 31st December, was
as follows :
1986
1987
1988
1989
()
()
()
()
22,000
43,000
28,000
103
Bonus issue of 1 for 4
-----
------
16,000
-----
( 1.1.88)
27000
Profit for the year
14000
30000
7000
(8000)
30000
52000
34000
20000
Proposed Dividend
8000
9000
6000
Nil
Bal. c/d
22000
43000
28000
20000
The only increase in issued share capital during this period has been from the
bonus issue on 1st January 1988. Ans.(a) Goodwill 26750 M. Int. 25000 (b)
Goodwill 23125 M. Int. 37500)
Question No. 5
The balance sheets of S Ltd. and T Ltd. as at 31.3. 1994 were as below:
S Ltd.
T Ltd.
Rs.
Rs.
Liabilities
Share Capital ( Rs. 10 each)
5,00,000
2,00,000
Reserves
2,40,000
1,00,000
57,200
82,000
Bank Overdraft
80,000
Bills Payable
8,400
104
Creditors
47,100
9,000
9,24,300
3,99,400
1,50,000
1,80,000
2,40,000
1,35,000
Investment in T Ltd.
3,40,000
Stock
1,20,000
36,400
Sundry Debtors
44,000
40,000
Bills Receivable
15,800
Cash
14,500
8,000
9,24,300
3,99,400
Assets
S Ltd. had acquired 16,000 shares of T Ltd. on 1st October, 1993. The profit and
loss account of T Ltd. stood at Rs. 30,000 (credit) on 31st March, 1993 out of
which a dividend of 10 per cent was paid on 1st November, 1993. S Ltd. had
credited its share of dividend to its profit and loss account.
S Ltd. had sold an item of machinery to T Ltd. on hire-purchase basis. In
respect of this machinery, the following were the balances in its books as of 31st
March, 1994 :
Rs. 5,000
Installments due
Installments not due Rs. 2,000
HP Stock Reserve
Rs. 400
The above stood included under appropriate heads in the balance sheets.
Prepare the consolidated balance sheet of the two companies as on 31st March,
1994. [CA (Final), May 1994]
Revenue
profit
105
1993)
General reserve* 1.4.1993
P & L a/c 1.4.1993
Less dividend for year ended 31.3.1993
Profit for year ended 31.3.1994
Total
Holding companys share ( 80%)
( 1.10.1993
31.3.1994)
1,00,000
30,000
20,000
10,000
36,000
1,46,000
1,46,000 x 0.80
= 1,16,800
1,46,000 x 0.20
= 29,200
36,000
36,000
36,000 x 0.80
= 28,800
36,000 x 0.20
= 7,200
Minority interest : Paid up value 40000 + capital profit 29200 + revenue profit
7200 = 76400
Cost of control
Cost of shares
3,40,000
-1,60,000
- 16,000
- 1,16,800
Goodwill
47,200
106
Question No. 6
Summarized Balance Sheets of A Ltd. and its subsidiary company B Ltd. as on
31st March, 1977, are given below :
E. shares
7,00,000 2,00,000
FA
----
15000
3,85,000
3,25,000
( Rs.10)
7% Pref. share
1,60,000
capital (Rs.10)
G. Reserve
equity 3,30,000
---
shares in B
-----
80,000
12000 pref.
1,20,000
----
20,000
----
Shares in B
P&L
2,97,000
88,800
Rs.20000 Debs.
in B
6% Deb.
-----
40,000
----
11,200
60,000
20,000
Deb. Interest
-----
1,200
Crs.
1,80,000
72,000
Total
1,80,000 6,73,200
CA
3,82,000
3,48,200
Total
12,37,000 6,73,200
accrued
( 6 months )
107
Relevant informations:
(a) A Ltd. acquired the shares in B Ltd. on 31st March, 1976.
(b) The general reserve of B Ltd. as on 31st March, 1976 was the same as on
31st March, 1977.
(c) The balance in the profit & loss account of B Ltd. is made up as follows:
(Rs.)
56,000
64,000
120000
Less : Proposed Dividends
31,200
88,800
(d) The stock of B Ltd. as on 31st March 1977 includes Rs. 36,000 in respect of
goods purchased from A Ltd. on which the later company made a profit of 20
per cent above cost.
(e) The balance in the profit and loss account of B Ltd. as on 31st March, 1976
is after providing for the preference dividend of Rs. 11,200 and a proposed
equity dividend of Rs. 15,000 both of which were subsequently paid but the
proportionate amount due to A Ltd. was inadvertently credited by it to its
profit & loss account.
(f)
No entries had been made in the books of A Ltd. in respect of the debenture
interest, and the proposed dividends due from B Ltd. for the year ended 31st
March, 1977.
(g) On 31st March, 1977, B Ltd. made an issue of bonus shares for Rs. 80,000
by capitalizing the general reserve and issued pro-rata. The transaction had
not yet been shown in the books of B Ltd.
Prepared a consolidated balance sheet of A Ltd. and its subsidiary B Ltd. as on
31st March, 1977. ( M. Int. 140000 Con B/S total 1492550 Goodwill 58350)
108
Proposed Dividend of Subsidiary Co. (Three Types of Situations) II case
Proposed dividend of subsidiary company appears just as a note, i.e., neither
subsidiary company has passed the entry proposing the dividend nor holding
company has passed the entry for receivable amount of proposed dividend.
There are two ways of dealing with this situation: (a) Taking proposed
dividend as a separate item; (b) Taking proposed dividend as part of P&L A/c.
(Actually in this way, we have to do nothing, we just ignore the note regarding
proposed dividend of subsidiary company). We prefer the second way.
Proposed Dividend of Subsidiary Co. (Three Types of Situations) III case
B Ltd.
A Ltd.
B Ltd.
Share Capital
(Rs. 10 each) 2,00,000 1,00,000
Reserve
Profit &
Loss A/c
40,000
Fixed Assets
28,000
1,60,000
Investments 1,00,000
Debtors
20,00018,000
25,000 35,000
1,10,000
15,000
109
Creditors
O. Liabilities
29,000 20,000
3,47,000
2,09,000
3,47,000 2,09,000
Additional information:
(1) At the time of acquiring shares, B Ltd. had Rs. 24,000 in reserve and
Rs. 15,000 in profit & loss account.
(2) B Ltd. has paid 11 per cent dividend in 1976, 12 per cent in 1977 and 15 per
cent in 1978 for 1975, 1976 and 1977 respectively. All dividends received
have been credited to the profit and loss account of A Ltd.
(3) Proposed dividend of both the companies for 1978 is 12 per cent.
(4) A bonus dividend of one full paid share of 5 held has been declared by
B Ltd. out of pre-acquisition reserve. No effect has been given to that in the
above accounts.
(5) On 1.1.76 building of B Ltd. which stood in the books at Rs. 50,000 was
revalued at Rs. 60,000 but no adjustment has been made in the books.
Depreciation has been charged @ 10 per cent p.a. on reducing balance
method.
(6) In 1978, A Ltd. purchased from B Ltd. goods for Rs. 10,000 on which B Ltd.
made a profit of 20 per cent on sales, 25 per cent on such goods are lying
unsold on 31st December, 1978.
You are required to prepare a consolidated balance sheet as on 31st
December, 1978.( Cap. Reserve Rs.29200,
M. Int. 33658
472790)
Question No. 8 :
A Ltd. made an offer to acquire all the shares in B Ltd. at a price of Rs. 25 per
share, to be satisfied by the allotment of five shares in A Ltd. for every four
shares in B Ltd. By the date of expiration of the offer, which was January 1, 1978
110
shareholders owning 60 per cent of the shares in B Ltd. had accepted the offer,
and the acquisition was effective from that date.
The accounting date of B Ltd. was 31st March in each year but to confirm with
A Ltd., accounts were prepared to 30th June, 1978, covering the fifteen months
to the date.
The draft summarized account of the companies as on 30th June, 1978 which
do not include any entries regarding the acquisition of shares in B Ltd. were as
follows :
Balance Sheet as on 30th June, 1978
A Ltd.
B Ltd.
Rs.
Rs.
Authorised
3,00,000
75,000
1,50,000
60,000
3,17,000
20,000
Current Liabilities
27,000
7,000
33,000
6,000
5,27,000
93,000
Freehold Property
2,00,000
38,000
2,32,000
9,000
7,000
Stock at cost
32,000
21,000
Debtors
41,000
17,000
Balance at Bank
15,000
8,000
Rs.
General Reserve
55,000
2,62,000
111
5,27,000
93,000
A Ltd.
B. Ltd.
One year
15 months
Rs.
Rs.
2,14,000
7,500
80,000
22,500
2,94,000
30,000
32,000
6,000
4,000
2,62,000
20,000
2,94,000
30,000
Revenue
(pre 1.1.78)
profit
(1.1.78-
112
30.6.78)
Profit b/d
7500
---
16500x(9/15)
16500x(6/15)
Interim dividend
- 4000
-----
Total
13400
6600
13400 x 0.60
6600 0.60
=8040
= 3960
13400 x 0.40
6600 x 0.40
=5360
Minority interest
Cost of control
Paid up capital
24000
Cost of shares
90000
Capital profit
5360
Paid up value
-36000
Revenue profit
2640
Capital profit
-8040
Total
32000
Goodwill
45960
195000
Goodwill
45960
S. Prem.
45000
Freehold
238000
GR
55000
Plant
241000
Investment
7000
Stock
53000
P&L
262000
+3960
226960
CL
34000
113
Tax
39000
Drs.
58000
39000
Bank
23000
M. Int.
32000
Total
665960
Total
665960
Question No. 9
H Ltd. purchased on 1.4.1985, 8,000 equity shares of Rs. 100 each in S Ltd.
when S Ltd. had Rs. 10,00,000 share capital. It sold 500 such shares on
1.4.1986 and purchased 1000 shares on 1.4.1987.S Ltd. paid 15 per cent
dividend each year in September and there was no change in share capital
account up to 31.3.1988.
Profit and loss account balances in S Ltd. and investments of H Ltd. in S Ltd.
on different dates were as under:
Investment of
H Ltd. in S Ltd.
Rs.
Rs.
5,00,000
12,80,000
6,20,000
12,80,000
7,00,000
11,90,000
8,00,000
14,00,000
114
Question No. 10 Study Material Self Examination Questions Q. No. 11 Minor Ltd
Page 4.87
Question No. 11
As on 30th June, 1975, the balance sheets of three companies showed the
following positions:
Fig Ltd.
Rs.
Share Capital
2,00,000
Rs.
Land and Buildings
Capital Reserve
20,000
Revenue Reserve
60,000
Current Liabilities
Creditors
at cost
40,000
80,000
1,15,000
Provision for
taxes
40,000
at cost
50,000
Proposed
dividend 1,00,000 1,90,000
70,000
Stock in hand
57,000
Sundry debtors
83,000
Balance at Bank
25,000
4,70,000
4,70,000
Run Ltd.
Rs.
Share Capital
(10 each)
80,000
Rs.
Land and Buildings
Plant & Machinery
1,00,000
35,000
115
Capital Reserve
40,000
Revenue Reserve
42,000
Current Assets
Stock in hand 65,000
Current Liabilities
Debtors
Creditors
40,000
Proposed
dividend
40,000
1,65,000
80,000
Provision
for tax
18,000 1,38,000
3,00,000
3,00,000
Trot Ltd.
Rs.
Share Capital
1,00,000
(10 each)
Rs.
Land and Buildings
Plant & Machinery
Capital Reserve
Revenue Reserve
65,000
25,000
32,000
Current Assets
Stock in hand60,000
Current Liabilities
Debtors
Creditors
Bank Balance10,000
23,000
Proposed
dividend
40,000
1,10,000
10,000
Provision
for tax
35,000
68,000
2,00,000
2,00,000
116
1. Fig Ltd. acquired 5,000 shares in Run Ltd. in 1970, when the balance on
capital reserve had been Rs. 20,000 and on revenue reserve Rs. 16,000.
A further 1000 shares were purchased in 1972 when the balance capital
reserve and revenue reserve had been Rs. 40,000 and Rs. 24,000
respectively.
2. Fig Ltd. had purchased 7,500 shares in Trot Ltd. in 1971 when there had
been adverse balance on revenue reserve of Rs. 6,000.
3. The proposed dividends from subsidiary companies have been
included in the figure for debtors in the accounts of the parent company.
You are required to prepare the consolidated balance sheet of Fig. Ltd. and
its subsidiaries as on 30th June, 1975, together with your consolidated
schedules. ( Goodwill 24000 Total of con. B/S 741500)
Question No. 12
On 1.1.1980, A Ltd. acquired 90 per cent of the shares in B Ltd. and 80 percent
of the shares in C Ltd. With a view to increase the holding in C Ltd. from 80 per
cent to 90 per cent, A Ltd. sold 10 per cent of shares in B Ltd. at Rs. 160 per
share on 30.06.1980 crediting the proceeds to investment account and fully
utilized the same to acquire 10 per cent of shares in C Ltd. The investment
account in A Ltd. is carried at cost except the account, representing the
investment in B Ltd. which has been credited with the sale proceeds of 400
shares amounting to Rs. 64,000. The balance sheets are as under, as on
31.12.1980 :
A. Ltd.
B. Ltd.
C. Ltd.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
7,00,000
4,00,000
2,00,000
Other Liabilities
3,77,000
1,35,000
2,00,000
P&L A/c
2,33,000
1,10,000
3,50,000
117
13,10,000
6,45,000
7,50,000
Fixed Assets
1,20,000
3,80,000
3,40,000
Current Assets
2,27,000
2,40,000
4,10,000
95,000
25,000
Loans
Investments
B Ltd.
4,40,000
C Ltd.
4,28,000
13,10,000
6,45,000
7,50,000
3,33,000
1,20,000
2,90,000
40,000
30,000
80,000
3,73,000
1,50,000
3,70,000
1,40,000
40,000
20,000
2,33,000
1,10,000
3,50,000
Dividend Paid
118
The following summarized balance sheet as on December 31, 1977 as given :
A Ltd. B Ltd.
Rs.
Rs.
20,00,000
5,00,000
6,00,000
2,40,000
2,25,000
Bank Overdraft
Sundry Creditors
Fixed Assets
1,50,000
2,40,000
2,10,000
30,65,000
11,00,000
16,00,000
5,00,000
Investment:
(i) In B Ltd.
4,72,500
(ii) Other
5,70,000
Loan to A Ltd.
2,00,000
Cash at Bank
1,20,000
16,000
3,02,500
3,84,000
30,65,000
11,00,000
119
4. A Ltd. has purchased 3,500 shares in B Ltd. on April 1, 1977 but had
disposed of 375 shares on October 31, 1977 at Rs. 140 the sale
proceeds of being credited to the concerned investment account which so
far has only this entry in addition to that made on the acquisition of the
shares.
Prepare consolidated balance sheet. ( Total of Cons.B/s 3467500 Capital
Reserve 66000 M. Int. 148000)
Chain Holding
Let A Ltd. be holding company of B Ltd. and B Ltd. be holding company of
C Ltd., we refer C Ltd. as bottom company and B Ltd. as middle company. In this
case, first we should make analysis of profit of C Ltd. and then that of B Ltd. B
Ltds share in revenue profit of C Ltd. should be added to the revenue profit of B
Ltd. (Between B Ltd. and C Ltd., B Ltd. is holding comapny and C Ltd. is
subsidiary company We studied in Rule (vii) regarding preparing consolidated
balance sheet that holding companys share in revenue profit, i.e., postacquisition profit of subsidiary company should be added to the concerned
account of holding company). What about B Ltds share in capital profit of C Ltd.?
In this connection there are two opinions. One opinion is that as we transfer
revenue profit from C Ltd. to B Ltd., on the same basis we should transfer capital
profit from C Ltd. to B Ltd. The other opinion is that we should not transfer capital
profit from C Ltd. to B Ltd. (And this capital profit, i.e., B Ltd.s share in capital
profit of C Ltd., should be directly transferred to cost of control). The logic is that
between B Ltd. and C Ltd. B Ltd. is holding company and in case of holding
company, we take only its share in post-acquisition profit of its subsidiary.
120
Question No. 14
From the following data, you are required to prepare the consolidated balance
sheet of a group of companies :
Balance Sheet As on 31st December, 1982
Share
A Ltd
B Ltd
C Ltd
A Ltd
B Ltd
C Ltd
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
250000
200000
120000
FA
56000
110000
75000
36000
20000
14400
Shares
170000
36000
106000
capital
Reserves
in B
Ltd.
P&L
32000
4000
10200
Shares
in C
Ltd.
C Ltd
6600
Stock
24000
Crs.
14000
10000
B Ltd.
16000
A Ltd
14000
Drs.
36600
32000
63000
A Ltd.
6600
Total
338000
248000
144600
Total
338000
248000
144600
121
(ii) The share capital of all companies is divided into shares of
Rs. 100 each.
(iii) B Ltd. held 800 shares of C Ltd.
(iv) All investments were made on 30th June, 1982.
(v) There were the following balances on 1st January, 1982 :
B Ltd.
Rs.
Reserves
Profit and Loss A/c
C Ltd.
Rs.
18,000
12,000
2,000
1,680
(vi) Dividends have not been declared by any company during the year nor
are any proposed.
(vii) B Ltd. sold goods coating Rs. 8,000 to A Ltd. at the price of Rs. 8,800
these goods were still unsold on 31.12.1982.
(viii) A Ltd. remitted Rs. 2,000 to B Ltd. on 30th December, 1982 but the same
was not received by B Ltd. by 31st December, 1982.
(Goodwill 17955 M. Interest 68960 Total of Conso. B/s 415755)
Chain-Holdings and Different Dates of Acquisitions : Steps
(i) Make analysis of profit of bottom company;
(ii) Note the following dates:
(a) Date(s) on which top company acquired shares in middle company;
(b) Date of Consolidated Balance Sheet.
(iii) Find profit (reserve & surplus) of middle company on the above-mentioned
dates. By profit of middle company we mean its own profit and its share in
post-acquisition profit of its subsidiary company (i.e., bottom company);
(iv) Make analysis of profit of middle company;
(v) Minority Interest;
(vi) Cost of control
122
(vii) Consolidated Balance Sheet.
Question No. 15
The following are the balance sheets of A Ltd., B Ltd. and C Ltd. as at 31st
December, 1972 : (Prepare consolidated Balance Sheets).
A Ltd.
B Ltd.
C. Ltd.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Share capital
(Rs. 100 each)
10,00,000
5,00,000
General Reserve
2,00,000
36,000
1,70,000
1,19,000
Liabilities
1,60,000
3,75,000
1,40,000
15,30,000
10,30,000
3,40,000
25,000
Other Assets
90,000
2,00,000
80,000
9,05,000
9,40,000
2,60,000
15,30,000
10,30,000
3,40,000
123
2. A Ltd. acquired its investment in C Ltd. on 1st January 1972 when the
debit balance in the profit and loss account in C Ltd.s book was
Rs. 60,000.
3. B Ltd. acquired its investment in C Ltd. on 1st January 1970 when the
debit balance in the profit and loss account in C Ltd.s book was
Rs. 20,000. ( M. Int. 122000 goodwill 89000 total of con. B/S 2194000 )
Question No. 16
The balance sheet of three companies showed the following position as on June
30, 1980 :
A Ltd.
B Ltd.
Rs.
Fixed assets
240000
Shares in B Ltd.
Rs.
84000
C Ltd.
Rs.
111000
1,25,000
Shares in C Ltd.
1,60,000
Current Assets :
Stock-in-trade
42,400
50,300
61,200
Debtors
82,390
46,610
44,300
1,30,400
22,350
77,750
6,20,190
3,63,260
2,94,250
2,50,000
1,00,000
1,50,000
Bank Balance
Share Capital :
Authorised & Issued
E. shares of Rs. 10
each
124
Reserve and Surplus :
Capital Reserve
40,000
30,000
Revenue Reserve
77,496
61,420
32,425
Creditors
80,194
90,940
16,340
Income-tax
72,500
60,900
35,485
1,00,000
50,000
30,000
6,20,190
3,63,260
2,94,250
Current Liabilities
and Provisions :
Prop. Dividends
125
Question No. 17
The following are the balance sheet of A Ltd., B Ltd., & C Ltd. as on 31.12.1984.
A Ltd.
B Ltd.
C Ltd.
5,00,000
2,50,000
1,00,000
50,000
15,000
10,000
Revenue Reserve
1,00,000
75,000
60,000
Other Liabilities
3,50,000
1,60,000
80,000
Fixed Assets
3,20,000
1,60,000
30,000
Shares in B Ltd.
4,50,000
Shares in C Ltd.
50,000
1,00,000
1,80,000
2,40,000
Current Assets
2,20,000
( M.
126
Consolidated Profit and Loss Account should be prepared in columnar form.
Draw on each side one column for each company, one column for adjustments
and one for total. The account may be divided into three parts. In the first part,
we determine profits. Second part is concerned with appropriation of profits.
Dividends received/receivable by holding company from subsidiary company are
also credited to this part. In third part, we make rectification and three
consolidation adjustments. In first two parts, inter-company transactions are
eliminated.
The rectification in the third part of this account relates to dividend received
by holding company out of pre-acquisition profits of subsidiary company, i.e., if
holding companys column of this P&L A/c has been credited with pre-acquisition
dividend (i.e., dividend out of pre-acquisition profit of subsidiary company) of
subsidiary company such dividend should be transferred to Investment in shares
of Subsidiary A/cs by debiting the amount in holding company column of
Consolidated P&L A/c. The three adjustments are:
(i) Minoritys share in profits of subsidiary company as appearing in this P&L A/c;
(ii) holding companys share in capital profit of subsidiary company, as appearing
in this P&L A/c; (iii) Stock reserve.
Interim Dividend of Subsidiary Company
(i) If interim dividend relates to any particular period, charge it against profit of
that period.
(ii) If it does not relate to particular period:
(a) Paid in pre-acquisition period-charge against profits of pre-acquisition
period. (Example: Q. No. 8). The reason is that because of this dividend,
the book value of shares on the date of acquisition got reduced. To find
this reduced book value, we reduce capital profit which can be done by
charging this interim dividend against pre-acquisition profit.
127
(b) Paid in post-acquisition period we should pro-rata this dividend against
profits of current year on the basis of pre-acquisition and post-acquisition
profits of current year.
Question No. 19
H Ltd. holds 3000 equity shares of Rs. 100 each in S Ltd. whose capital consist
of 4,000 equity shares of Rs. 100 each and 6 per cent 1,000 cumulative
preference shares of Rs. 100 each. S Ltd. has also issued 6 per cent debenture
to the extent of Rs. 2,00,000 out of which H Ltd. hold Rs. 1,00,000. The following
are the profit & loss account of the two companies for the year ending 31st
December, 1976.
H Ltd. S Ltd.
H Ltd.
S Ltd.
To Adjusted
Purchases
15,00,000
6,00,000
By Sales 19,00,000
15,00,000
To Manu.
Expenses
To G,P.
4,00,000
4,00,000
5,00,000
19,00,000
15,00,000
128
To sundry
By Gross
Expenses
1,50,000
2,00,000
To Debenture
Profit
4,00,0005,00,000
By Deb
Interest
To Profit C/d
12,000
2,98,000
Interest
2,88,000
4,48,000
5,00,000
-----
By Interim
Dividend
6,000
------
To Income
42000
4,48,000
5,00,000
By Profit
Tax
1,40,000
1,20,000 B/D
2,98,0002,88,000
To Preference
Dividends
6,000
To dividend
(interim)
56,000
To Proposed
dividend
To Bal. c/d
1,00,000
84,000
58,000
22,000
2,98,000
2,88,000
2,98,000
2,88,000
129
Question No. 20
On 1st February, 79, A Ltd. purchased 2,70,000 equity shares and 9,000
preference shares in B Ltd. Both the companies makes up their accounts on 30th
June each year. The following figures are extracted from the companies records
for the year ended on 30th June, 79 :
Sales
A Ltd.
B Ltd.
Rs.
Rs.
1,62,00,000 1,53,00,000
Purchase
Selling Expenses
Overhead Expenses
89,63,820
86,86,440
8,10,000
12,15,000
20,70,000
9,45,000
13,50,000
7,20,000
81,000
8,93,700
18,05,040
54,00,000
36,00,000
18,00,000
4,81,500
5,76,000
130
5. B Ltd. sold to A Ltd. in March 79 material for Rs. 7,50,000 at cost plus 25
per cent of which A Ltd. still had unsold stock of Rs. 5,00,000 (at cost to
A Ltd.) as on 30th June, 79.
Prepare consolidated profit and loss account of A Ltd. and its subsidiary B
Ltd. for the year ended on 30th June, 79.
131
Question No. 21
The trial balances of X Ltd. and Y Ltd. as at 31st December, 1968 are given below:
X Ltd.
X Ltd.
Y Ltd.
Y Ltd.
Dr. Rs.
Cr. Rs.
Dr. Rs.
Cr. Rs.
---
10,00,000
---
1,00,000
1,00.000
2,00,000
37,000
----
80,000
20,000
132
6% Debentures of Y
Drs.
50,000
2,05,940
Crs.
Purchases
62,208
1,48,000
4,00,000
Sales
Opening stock
1,00,000
92,860
3,00,000
8,00,000
1.00.000
Deb. Int.
7,00,000
50,000
3,000
6,000
Salaries
35,000
20,000
Gen. exp.
57,000
40,475
1,200
3,000
1,260
2,700
Source
Bank
Equity shares in Y Ltd
Pref. shares in Y Ltd
10,000
8,000
2,50,000
40,000
5,90,040
@ 10% p.a.)
Dep. On FA
97,000
65,560
Wages
70,000
50,000
Total
2189200
2189200
1195560
Additional information :
(i) Closing Stock : X Ltd. Rs. 2,00,000; Y Ltd. Rs. 15,000.
1195560
133
(ii) Shares in Y Ltd. were acquired on 1.4.1968 and consisted of 75 per cent of
equity capital and 40 per cent or preference capital. Half of the debentures
of Y Ltd. were acquired by X Ltd. on 1.1.1968.
(iii) After acquisition of control X Ltd. bought good from Y Ltd. at selling price
(which is cost plus 25%) valued at Rs. 40,000. One-fourth of these goods
was still in the closing stock of X Ltd. These goods were valued at cost to X
Ltd. for valuation of its closing stock.
(iv) Included in the fixed assets of Y Ltd. is machinery which stood in the books
on 1.1.1968 at Rs. 1,00,000 and on which depreciation had been written off
at 10 per cent p.a. It was revalued at Rs. 1,20,000 on the date of
acquisition of control, i.e., 1.4.1968. This appreciation in the value of
machinery remains unrecorded as yet.
(v) Proposed dividend on equity shares : X Ltd. 10 %; Y Ltd. 15%.
Prepare a consolidated profit and loss account of X Ltd. and Y Ltd. for the
year ended 31.12.1968 and a consolidated balance sheet as on that date.
134
135
10,00,000
Goodwill
49,396
Reserve
2,00,000
FA
14,83,852
P & L a/c
2,78,921
Drs.
2,68,148
2,13,000
Deb.
50,000
Crs.
2,40,860
Bank
18,000
TDS
2,700
TDS
1,260
1,00,000
Minority interest
1,61,175
20,33,656
20,33,656
136
Question No. 22
The following information was extracted from the books of A Ltd. Group as on 3112.80 :
A Ltd.
Rs.
B Ltd.
Rs.
C Ltd.
Rs.
50,000
36,000
26,000
60,000
1,10,000
42,000
28,000
78,000
54,000
40,000
30,000
20,000
137
70,000
Net trading profit earned in 1980
(before taking into account proposed
dividends of 10% in respect of
calendar year 1980)
50,000
1,20,000
Dividend Received :
From B Ltd. in 1979
From B Ltd. in 1980
From C Ltd.
Share Capital Authorised and
Full paid, Equity Shares of
Re. 1 each
Current Liabilities
48,000
34,000
50,000
30,000
98,000
64,000
20,000
25,000
15,000
4,00,000
20,000
5,85,000
3,00,000 2,00,000
5,000
17,000
4,18,000 2,81,000
2,10,000
60,000
1,88,000 2,61,000
30,000
20,000
2,50,000
65,000
2,00,000
5,85,000 4,18,000 2,81,000
-----------------
All the companies pay dividends of 10 per cent on paid up share capital in
March following the end of the accounting year. The receiving companies enter
the dividends in their books when the dividends are received. Prepare
138
consolidated P&L account for year ended 31.12.1980 and consolidated balance
sheet as on 31.12.1980.
4,00,000
Goodwill
P&L
2,08,417
FA
6,59,000
42,000
CA
1,10,000
CL
M. Int.
17,500
1,36,083
7,86,500
7,86,500
Inter-company Holdings
(i) Find capital profit and revenue profit on the basis of simultaneous equation.
(ii) In consolidated balance sheet, we take only that part of share capital of
holding company, which is being held by shareholders other than subsidiary
company.
139
(iii) In consolidated balance sheet, we do not take Investment in shares of
holding company as appearing in subsidiary consolidated balance sheet.
(iv) Cost of control to be adjusted by difference between Amount of Investment
in shares of holding company as appearing in subsidiary balance sheet and
paid value of such shares.
(v) Profits to be reduced by subsidiary companys share in profits of holding
company.
Question No. 23
Following are the summarized balance sheets of two companies H Ltd. and S
Ltd. as at 31st December, 1976 :
H Ltd.
S Ltd.
H Ltd.
Share Capital
Fixed Assets18,10,000
(Rs.10 each) 25,00,000 12,50,000 1,00,000
Reserves
7,50,000 5,00,000 shares in
Creditors
2,25,000 2,00,000 S Ltd.
11,00,000
25,000 shares
in H Ltd.
C. Assets 5,65,000
34,75,000 19,50,000
34,75,000
S Ltd.
13,00,000
2,75,000
3,75,000
19,50,000
140
(ii) The amounts of subsidiary companys profit (less loss) which is attributable
to holding company and which has not been dealt with in the accounts of
holding company: (a) For the financial year of subsidiary company ending
with or within financial year of holding company, (b) For the previous
financial year of subsidiary company since it became subsidiary company;
(iii) Information similar to (ii) as to the profits and losses of subsidiary company
which have been dealt with in the accounts of holding company.
(B) Where holding company and subsidiary company have different financial
years, the following information have to be given in the statement:
(i) The changes, if any, in the holding companys shareholdings in subsidiary
company, during the time-gap (from end of financial year of subsidiary
company to the date of balance sheet of holding company to which the
statement is attached).
(ii) Details of any material changes which have occurred during time gap in
respect of subsidiarys fixed assets, investments, lendings and borrowings
(other than for the purpose of meeting current liabilities).
Question No. 24
From the following particulars, prepare a statement to be attached to the balance
sheet of X Ltd. as on 31.3.1988.
(1) X Ltd. purchased 2,800 shares of Y Ltd. on 1.1.1986 for Rs. 3,50,000.
Issued capital of Y Ltd. has been 4,000 shares of Rs. 100 each.
(2) On 1.1.1986 Y Ltd. had general reserve of Rs. 3,00,000 and P&L A/c Cr.
Balance of Rs. 1,00,000. Ys accounting year is calendar year.
(3) Y Ltd. made profit (post tax) of Rs. 1,00,000 in 1986 and of Rs. 1,10,000 in
1987. (4) Y Ltd. declared and paid dividend of 20 per cent for each of these
two years. (5)
141
(ii) Y Ltd. issued 13.5 per cent redeemable debentures of Rs. 2,00,000 to
finance the purchase of a machine. This machine was purchased and
installed in March 1988 at a cost of Rs. 2,10,000.
(iii) Y Ltd. purchased shares of Z Ltd. for Rs. 10,000.
(iv) Y Ltd. advanced a loan of Rs. 10,000 at 18 per cent to A Ltd. A Ltd.
supplies material to Y Ltd.
Rs. 14,000
142
(ii) Other years since
acquisition
Rs. 56,000
31.3.1988
5. Material changes during
1.1.1988-31.3.1988 in
respect of following
items of Y Ltd.
(i)
Fixed Assets
(ii) Investments
(iii) Lendings
Advanced
18
per
cent
Loan
of
CONSOLIDATED
FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS AS-21
143
statements ). The AS clarifies that the consolidated financial statements are not
in lieu of separate financial statement of the parent.
Control means the power to govern the financial and operating policies of an
enterprise so as to obtain benefits from its activities. Control is obtained by one
or both of the following two ways
(i)
(ii)
144
In this case, the investment in the subsidiary should be accounted for in the
consolidated financial statements in accordance with AS-13.
any excess of the cost to the parent of its investments in a subsidiary over the
parents portion of equity of the subsidiary , at the date on which investment in
the subsidiary is made, should be described as goodwill to be recognized as an
asset in the CFSs
when the cost to the parent of its in subsidiary is less than the parents portion
of equity of subsidiary, at the date on which investment in subsidiary is made, the
difference should be treated as a capital reserve in the CFSs
Two or more investments ( Refer to paragraph 15 of the AS )
145
Question No. 25: Study material Self Examinations Questions Q. No. 23 A Ltd.
page 4.96
25,000
Capital profit
-1,000
7,500
2,500
_______do---( equity )
91,000 x 0.25
1,11,750
Cost of control :
shares
Cost of
96000 + 80000 +36000 = 2,12,000
-1,65,000
-15,000
-7,000
-(-3000)
28.000
Amount
1,08,000
1,21,000
2,35,000
1,00,000
83,000
99,200
146
B/P
M. Interest
Total
2,000
1,11,750
10,42,200
* P & L a/c
Cash
Drs.
Total
1,30,000
+68250
+ 1500
Pre-acquisition dividend
-7000
Stock reserve
-800
1,46,000
1,50,000
10,42,200
Post
Post
1,91,950
Q. No. 26 : Study Material Illustration 20 Eagle , Garuda and Bird page 4.58
Unrealized profit or losses ( Refer to paragraph 16 of AS )
147
Minority interests should be presented in the consolidated balance sheet
separately from liabilities and the equity of the parents shareholders. Minority
interests in the income of the group should also be separately presented.
Pref. dividend ( refer to paragraph 27 of the As-21 )
If a subsidiary has outstanding cumulative preference shares which are held
outside the group, the parent computes its share of profits or losses after
adjusting for the subsidiarys preference dividends, whether or not dividends
have been declared.
Tax expense : While preparing consolidated financial statements, the tax
expense to be shown in the consolidated financial statements should be
the aggregate of the amounts of tax expense ( comprising current tax &
deferred tax ) appearing in the separate financial statements of the parent
an its subsidiaries.
Disclosure :
A list containing following details in respect of each subsidiary company
should be given : (i) name (ii) country of incorporation, and (iii)
proportion of ownership interest proportion of voting right held ( if voting
right and ownership are not identical )
nature of relationship between the parent and the subsidiary if the parent
does not own more than 50 % voting right shares of the subsidiary
( directly or indirectly )
name(s) of the subsidiary(ies) of which accounting years are different
from that of parent company.
The parents share in the post acquisition reserves of a subsidiary,
forming part of corresponding reserves in the consolidated balance sheet,
is not required to be disclosed separately in the consolidated balance
sheet.
148
149
find the value of goodwill. We should take profit for such number of years as may
reveal future trend of profits. We should take weighted average if profit has clear
trend, otherwise we should take simple average. Profit for goodwill purpose
means normal trading profit before appropriation. By number of years of
purchase, we mean weight or importance we attach to this average profit.
METHODS BASED ON SUPER PROFIT
Super Profit = Future Maintainable Profit Normal Profit.
Future Maintainable Profit
Buyer of goodwill is interested in future profits of the concern. Hence, for
determining value of goodwill, we estimate future maintainable profit on the basis
of following points :
(i) Take profits for a few years of past. We take profit for such number of
years as reveals the future trend of the profit e.g., if the profit has clear
trend we may take profit only for three years but if there is no clear trend,
we may take profit for 4 to 7 years.
(ii) Eliminate the effect of non-trade terms. For example:
Income from investment of surplus funds.
(iii) Eliminate the effect of abnormal items, for example, loss on account of
strike, flood, etc., abnormal profit on account of war, etc.
(iv) Eliminate the effect of such items which occurred in the past but which
are not likely to take place in the future.
(v) Take average of profits. If the profits have clear trend, take weighted
average, otherwise take simple average.
(vi) Take effect of such transactions into consideration which did not take
place in past but which would take place in future.
(vii) Consider Income-Tax.
Normal Profit
Normal Profit = Average capital Employed Normal Rate of Return
Normal rate of return may be given in the question. Alternatively, we may
have to estimate it on the basis of market price of share and dividend per share.
Under this approach, we assume that market value of share depends upon
dividend rate vis-a-vis normal rate.
Hence normal Rate
Dividend Per Share
=
Market Price per Share
100
If the question neither mentions the normal rate nor dividend per share and
market price of share, we just assume the normal rate. (We may assume any
rate between 10 to 20 per cent).
Capital employed, here, means owners investment in trade assets of the
business.
150
Capital Employed =
25
Lets understand this point clearly with the help of an example . A Ltd.s capital
employed on 1.1.2004 was Rs. 500000. It earned a profit of Rs. 365000 during the year
2003. Assume for simplicity that it operates for 365 days in a year and earns the profit
evenly. So the profit is Rs. 1000 per day. It paid a dividend of Rs. 100000 on 27th Dec.
2003. What is the average capital employed for the year 2003?
500000 + 860000
Average CE (1.1.2003 -27.12.2003 ) = -------------------------- = 680000
2
760000 +765000
Average CE (28.12.2003-31.12.2003) = ----------------------- = 762500
2
151
Open. C.E. + Clos. C.E. + Dividend paid at year end
=
2
If opening capital employed is not given, we assume that it is equal to closing
capital employed plus dividend paid at year end minus current year post tax
profit. Hence average capital employed
(Clos. C.E. + Dividend paid at year end Current year Post Tax Profit) +
Closing C.E. + Dividend at year and
= -------------------------------------2
= Closing C.E. + Dividend at year end Half of Current year Post Tax Profit.
An important point from past question papers: If the P&L A/c balance appearing
in balance sheet is less than current years profit, it can be assumed that
dividend has been paid. In the absence of amount of dividend, average capital
employed cannot be calculated. Hence, normal profit may be calculated on
closing capital employed. In other words, if payment of dividend is a fact or
assumption and we do not know the amount of dividend, average capital
employed cannot be calculated, In this case, we calculate normal profit on the
basis of closing capital employed.
Based on super profit, goodwill can be calculated by following methods:
Purchase of Super profit Method:
Goodwill = Super profit No. of years of purchase
For example, if super profit = Rs. 10,000 and establishment of new business
requires 3 years,
Goodwill = Rs. 10,000 3 = Rs. 30,000.
Annuity Method: Goodwill = Super Profit Annuity.
152
Advocates of annuity method put forward the plea that we pay for goodwill
now and get its benefits in future. Hence, value of goodwill should not be
calculated on the basis of number of years of purchase. (If it is done, the buyer of
goodwill suffers loss on account of interest. For example: If a person pays Rs.
30,000 for goodwill today and gets benefit from goodwill of Rs. 10,000 annually
for 3 years, i.e., he gets Rs. 10,000 after one year from today, another Rs.
10,000 after two years from today and yet another Rs. 10,000 after three years
from today; he paid Rs. 30,000, he got Rs. 30,000 but he suffered loss of
interest). They opine that the goodwill should be calculated on the basis of
annuity for number of years of purchase so that the buyer does not suffer loss on
account of interest:
Annuity
(1 + r)1
1
+
(1 + r)2
1
+ + . . . . . .
(1 + r)3
1
+
(1 + .10)1
1
+
(1 + .10)2
(1 + .10)3
= 2.487
153
100
154
E.P.S
Normal Rate
Market value ( Based on ROE)
ROE
Paid up value
Normal rate
Fair Value = Average of Intrinsic value and market value.
CHOICE OF METHOD
1.
2.
3.
4.
Fair value method is considered as most appropriate method when the value
to be determined is going to affect a fairly large number of shares. Like
acquiring controlling interest, amalgamation, etc., conversion of private
company to public company. For fair value, yield value may be calculated on
the basis of earnings.
Intrinsic value method may be applied when current value of goodwill is
given or is to be calculated.
In all other cases, yield value based on maximum possible dividend may be
applied.
Sometimes, the choice of method depends upon data/information given in
question.
Question No. 1
From the following information supplied to you, ascertain the value of goodwill of
A Ltd., which is carrying on business as retail under super profit method:
Balance Sheet as on 31st March, 1982
Rs.
Rs.
5,00,000
Goodwill at cost
50,000
Bank overdraft
1,16,700
2.20.000
Sundry creditors
1,81,000
2.00.000
155
39,000
Stock
3,00,000
P. & L a/c
1,13,300
Debtors
1.80,000
Total
9,50,000
9,50,000
1978
1979
1980
1981
1982
Rs.
40,000 (Loss)
88,000
1,03,000
1,16,000
1,30,000
Question No. 2
Negotiation is going on for transfer of X Ltd. on the basis of the balance sheet
and the additional information as given below:
Balance Sheet of X Ltd. as on 31st March, 1988
Rs.
Share capital (Rs.10
fully paid up )
10.00,000
Rs.
Goodwill
1,00,000
4,00,000
3,00,000
3,00,000
8,00,000
156
Investments
1,00,000
Stock
2,00,000
Debtors
1,50,000
50,000
17,00,000
Profit before tax for 1987-88 amounted to Rs. 6,00,000 including Rs. 10,000
as interest on investment. However, and additional amount of Rs. 50,000 p.a.
shall be required to be spent for smooth running of the business.
Market values of land & buildings and plant & machinery are estimated at Rs.
9,00,000 and Rs. 10,00,000 respectively. In order to match the above figures
further depreciation to the extent of Rs. 40,000 should be taken into
consideration. Income-tax rate may be taken at 50 per cent. Return on capital at
the rate of 20 per cent before tax may be considered normal for this business at
the present stage.
It has been agreed that 4 years purchase of super profit shall be
taken as value of goodwill for the purpose of the deal. Value the goodwill.
[ Adapted November 1988]
Question No. 3
Below is given the balance sheet of Prosperous Ltd. as 31st March, 1977.
Rs.
Share Capital
Authorised & Issued
6,000 shares of Rs. 100
each fully paid up
6,00,000
Profit & Loss A/c
40,000
Bank Overdraft
10,000
Creditors
80,000
Provision for Taxation
1,00,000
Proposed Dividend
60,000
8,90,000
Rs.
Land and Building 2,70,000
Plant and Machinery 1,00,000
Stock
3,60,000
Sundry Debtors
1,60,000
8,90,000
157
The net profits of the company, after deducting usual working expenses but
before providing for taxation, were as under :
Year
1972-73
Rs.
1,70,000
1973-74
2,10,000
1974-75
1,80,000
1975-76
2,20,000
1976-77
2,00,000
On 31st March, 1977, land & building were valued at Rs. 2,80,000 and plant
& machinery at Rs. 1,20,000. Sundry debtors, on the same date include Rs.
4,000 as irrecoverable.
Having regard to the nature of the business, a 10 per cent return on net
tangible capital invested, is considered reasonable.
You are required to value the companys share ex-dividend. Your own
valuation of goodwill may be based on five years purchase of annual super
periods. (The tax rate is to be assumed at 50 per cent).
[Closing CE = 728000, Ave. CE 679000, normal profit 67900, FM Profit
97600, super profit 28700, goodwill 148500, value of share 136.08 ]
Question No. 4
Balance Sheet of Sound Ltd. as at 31st March 1987 is given below :
Liabilities
Rs.
Assets
Share Capital
Fixed Assets:
6,000 Equity share of
Building
Rs. 100 each fully
Machinery
paid up
6,00,000 Current Assets
Profit & Loss A/c
50,000
Bank overdraft
10,000 Stock
Creditors
60,000 Sundry Debtors
Provision for Taxation 1,10,000 Bank
Proposed Dividend
60,000
Rs.
1,50,000
2,20,000
3,00,000
1,60,000
60,000
158
8,90,000
8,90,000
The net profits of the company, after deducting usual working expenses but
before providing for taxation, were as under :
Year
1984-85
1985-86
1986-87
Rs.
2,00,000
2,40,000
2,20,000
On 31st March, 1987, Building was revalued at Rs. 2,00,000 and machineries
Rs. 2,50,000. Sundry debtors, on the same date, included Rs. 10,000 as
irrecoverable. Having regard to nature of business, a 10 per cent return, on net
tangible capital invested, is considered reasonable.
You are required to value the companys share-ex-dividend. Valuation of
goodwill may be based on three years purchase of annual super profits.
Depreciation on building 2 per cent, machineries 10 per cent. The incometax rate is to be assumed at 50 per cent. All working should form part of your
answer.
[May 1987]
[Closing CE = 785000, Ave. CE 732500, normal profit 73250, FM Profit
106333, super profit 33083, goodwill 99249, value of share 137.38 ]
Question No. 5
On 31st March, 1991, the balance sheet of Menon Ltd. was as follows:
Rs.
Rs.
Share Capital
Land and Building 2,20,000
Authorised & Issued
Plant and Machinery95,000
5,000 Equity shares of
Stock
3,50,000
Rs. 100 fully paid 5,00,000 Sundry Debtors 1,55,000
Profit & Loss A/c
1,03,000
Bank Overdraft
20,000
Creditors
77,000
Provision for Taxation 45,000
Proposed Dividend
75,000
8,20,000
8,20,000
159
The net profits of the company, after deducting all working charges and
providing for depreciation and taxation, were as under :
Year ended 31st March
Rs.
1987
85,000
1988
96,000
1989
90,000
1990
1,00,000
1991
95,000
On 31st March, 1991, land and building were valued at Rs. 2,50,000 and
plant and machinery at Rs. 1,50,000.
In view of the nature of the business, it is considered that 10 per cent is a
reasonable return on tangible capital. Tax 35 per cent.
Prepare a valuation of the companys shares after taking into account the revised values of
fixed assets and your own valuation of goodwill based on five years purchase of the super
profits based on the average profit of the last five years. [Closing CE = 763000, Ave. CE
715500, normal profit 71550, FM Profit 93200, super profit 21650, goodwill
108250, value of share 159.25 ex-dividend]
Question No. 6
The following is the balance sheet of Moon and Co. Ltd. as on 31.3.1990:
Liabilities
Rs. Assets
Rs.
Share Capital:
Fixed Assets:
Eq. shares of Rs. 100 each10,00,000 Machines
6,00,000
Less: Calls in arrear
Factory shed
5,00,000
(Rs. 20 for final call)
1,00,000 Vehicles
2,00,000
9,00,000 Furniture
50,000
Reserve and Surplus:
Current Assets:
General Reserve
3,00,000 Stock
5,00,000
Profit & Loss A/c
4,00,000 Debtors
6,70,000
Current Liabilities:
Bank
50,000
Bank Overdraft
3,00,000 Miscellaneous Expenditure
Creditors
7,00,000 (to the extent not written
160
off) Pre. Expenses
26,00,000
30,000
26,00,000
Question No. 7
The following is the balance sheet of Star and Co. Ltd. as at 31st Dec. 1985:
Liabilities
Rs.
Share Capital
Equity Share of
Rs. 100 each
10,00,000
Less: Calls in arrear
(Rs. 20 for final call) 1,00,000
9,00,000
10% Preference share of
Rs. 10 each fully paid4,00,000
Reserves and Surplus:
General Reserve
4,00,000
Assets
Goodwill
Machinery
Factory shed
Vehicles
Furniture
Investments
Current Assets:
Stock-in-Trade
Sundry Debtors
Cash at Bank
Rs.
1,00,000
5,00,000
5,50,000
1,50,000
50,000
2,00,000
4,00,000
7,00,000
1,00,000
161
Profit & Loss A/c
Current Liabilities:
Bank Loan
Sundry Creditors
28,00,000
28,00,000
Rs.
4,75,000
Reserves and Surplus
General Reserve
2,00,000
Profit and Loss Account
50,000
162
7,25,000
On a revaluation of assets on 31st March, 1980, it was found that they had
appreciated by Rs. 75,000 over their book value in the aggregate.
The articles of association of the company provide that in case of liquidation,
preference shareholders would have a further claim to 10 per cent of the surplus
assets, if any.
You are required to determine the value of preference share and equity share
assuming that a liquidation of the company has to take place on 31st March,
1980, and that the expenses of winding up are nil.
Question No. 9
A Ltd. and its subsidiary B Ltd. get their supply of some essential raw materials
from C Ltd. To coordinate their production on a more profitable basis, A Ltd. and
C Ltd. agreed between themselves each to acquire a quarter of shares in the
others authorised capital by means of exchange of shares. The terms are as
follows:
(i) A Ltd.s shares are quoted at Rs. 14, but for the purpose of exchange the
value is to be taken at the higher of the two values (a) quoted and (b) on the
basis of the balance sheet valuation.
(ii) C. Ltd.s share which are unquoted are to be taken at the higher of the value
as on (a) yield basis and (b) the balance sheet basis. The future profits are
estimated at Rs. 1,05,000 subject to one-third to be retained for
development purposes. Shares of similar companies yield 8 per cent.
(iii) Freehold properties of C Ltd. are to be taken at Rs. 4,30,000.
(iv) No cash is to pass and the balance due on settlement is to be treated as
loan between the two companies.
The summarized balance sheets of the companies at the relevant date stood
as follows:
A Ltd.
Rs.
Authorised share capital equity
share of Rs. 10 each
Issued and Fully paid
Share Premium
7% Debentures
Profit & Loss A/c
Current Liabilities
Proposed Dividend
12,00,000
8,00,000
80,000
3,00,000
2,30,000
2,80,000
1,00,000
17,90,000
A Ltd.
B Ltd.
Rs.
C Ltd.
Rs.
5,00,000 10,00,000
5,00,000 7,50,000
2,10,000 2,00,000
1,80,000 2,10,000
50,000
9,40,000 11,60,000
B Ltd.
C Ltd.
163
Rs.
Rs.
Freehold Properties
6,60,000 2,90,000
Plant & Machinery etc.
4,50,000 4,10,000
Investments 40,000 shares in B Ltd. 4,70,000
Current Assets
2,10,000 2,40,000
Rs.
3,30,000
4,40,000
3,90,000
17,90,000 9,40,000 11,60,000
You are required to compute the value of the shares according to the terms of
the agreement and to present the final settlement showing all the workings.
Question No. 10
The following information relates to Good luck Pvt. Ltd. as at 31st December.
(Rupees in lakhs)
1977
1978
1979
18.80
10.00 10.00
4.50
5.50
5.50
6.50
.90
1.20
20.90 23.20
Goodwill
Building and Machinery (Less Dep.)
Stock-in-trade etc.
Debtors
Cash and Bank Balance
3.00
2.00
10.00 10.00
5.00
6.00
.90
2.50
2.00
2.70
20.90 23.20
4.00
9.00
4.00
.20
1.60
18.80
The following assets had been undervalued, their real worth to business
being:
(Rs. in lakhs)
Building & Machinery
10.00
Stock-in-trade etc.
5.20
Net Profit, after writing off Depreciation and
Provision for taxation and general reserve,
balance (including opening balance) 4.80
11.00
6.10
12.50
8.00
5.70
6.10
164
beginning of the year 1977 was Rs. 19,30,000 including the cost of goodwill and
balance in profit and loss account at the same time was Rs. 80,000. Tax 50 per
cent.
You are requested to prepare statement showing :
(a) Average capital employed during each of the three years.
(b) Goodwill on the basis of four years purchase of the average super profits
on a ten per cent yield basis.
(c) Yield value of shares.
1977
1978
1979
Average
Closing CE
13.50
15.50
20.20
Op. CE
15.30
13.50
15.50
Div. paid
4
4.8
4.9
Ave. CE
16.40
16.90
20.30
Normal profit
1.64
1.69
2.03
FM profit
5.60
6.85
7.65
6.70
Super profit
3.96
5.16
5.62
4.91333
Question No. 11
The summarized balance sheet of Jai Pvt. Ltd. as on 31st December, 1976 is as
follows:
Preference Share
(Rs. 100 each)
45000 Equity shares
(Rs. 10 each)
P&L A/c
5% Debentures 1980
Sundry Creditors
1,50,000
4,50,000
6,00,000
7,50,000
3,00,000
2,39,250
Fixed Assets
Goodwill
1,50,000
Freehold Property 3,75,000
Plant and Machinery1,50,000
6,75,000
Quoted Investment 3,00,000
Current Assets
Stock
2,70,000
Debtors (Net)
2,99,250
Bank Balance
3,45,000
165
18,89,250
18,89,250
A foreign investor shown interest in the companys business. You have been
appointed for suggesting the value of equity shares of the company. You gather
the following data :
Profits for the three years 1974, 1975 and 1976 after charging debenture
interest but before providing for preference dividend, were Rs. 2,20,500, Rs.
3,22,500 and Rs. 2,40,000 respectively.
(a) Preference shares are payable at par on liquidation.
(b) The purchaser wants to acquire all the 45,000 equity shares.
(c) (i)The normal rate of return 10 per cent.
(ii) The goodwill to be calculated at three times the adjusted average super
profits of the three years referred to above.
(iii) Debentures will be redeemed at a discount of 25 per cent prior to the sale
of the business.
(iv) The value of freehold property is agreed to be ascertained on the basis of
8 per cent return. The current rental value is Rs. 50,400.
(v) A claim of Rs. 8,250 was omitted to be provided in the year 1976.
(vi) Tax 35 per cent.
It is decided to sell the business, you are required to compute the purchase
price of equity shares after taking into consideration the following relevant facts:
(vii) Market value of quoted investment was Rs. 3,75,000.
(viii) Non-recurring profits are to be eliminated. 10 per cent of profits for 1975
referred to above arose from a transaction of a non-recurring nature.
(ix) A provision of 5 per cent on sundry debtors was made in 1976 which is
no longer required.
Question No. 12
Balance sheet of A Ltd. as on 31.12.1987 was as under:
Liabilities
Rs.
11,00,000
Assets
Rs.
Buildings
2,00,000
Plant and Machinery 4,00,000
Sundry Debtors
2,10,000
Stock
2,50,000
Cash and Bank
40,000
11,00,000
166
Year
1987
1986
1985
Profit
Rs.
3,20,000
2,50,000
2,20,000
Equity Dividend
18%
15%
12%
Land and buildings are worth Rs. 4,00,000. Managerial remuneration is likely
to go up by Rs. 20,000 p.a. Income-tax may be provided at 50 per cent. Equity
shares of companies in the same industry with dividend rate of 10 per cent are
quoted at par.
Find the most appropriate value of an equity share assuming that:
(a) Controlling interest is to be transferred.
(b) Only a few shares are to be transferred.
Ignore goodwill value, depreciation adjustment for revaluation and the need of
transfer to general reserve.
[May 1988]
Question No. 13
Mindtree Ltd. belongs to an industry in which equity shares sell at par on the
basis of 9 per cent dividend yield provided the net tangible assets of the
company are 300 per cent of the paid up capital and provided that the total
distribution of profit does not exceed 50 per cent of the profits. The dividend rate
fluctuates from year to year in the industry. The balance sheet of Mindtree Ltd.
stood as follows on 31.12.2004:
Liabilities
Rs.
7% Preference Shares
full paid (Rs. 100)
6,00,000
Equity shares of Rs. 80
paid (F.V. Rs. 100) 8,00,000
Revenue Reserve
4,00,000
6% Debentures
4,00,000
Current Liabilities
3,00,000
25,00,000
Assets
Goodwill
F.A. less Dep.
Investment
C.A.
Prel. Expenses
Rs.
1,00,000
16,00,000
1,50,000
6,30,000
20,000
25,00,000
The company has been earning on the average Rs. 4,00,000 as profit after
debenture interest but before tax which may be taken at 50 per cent. The rate of
dividend on equity shares has been maintained at 12 per cent in the past year
and is expected to be maintained. Determine the probable market value of the
167
equity shares of the company. The fixed assets may be taken to be worth Rs.
17,20,000.
Answer :Note 1
Paid up capital =
It is less than 300 % ( which is bench mark for the industry ). It is a negative
feature of the Mindtree as compared of industry. It should result in reduction of
value of Mindtree Ltd. For this purpose, we should raise the normal rate of
Mindtree Ltd.
It is less than 300 % ( which is bench mark for the industry ). It is a negative
feature of the Mindtree Ltd. as compared of industry. It should result in reduction
of value of Mindtree Ltd. For this purpose, we should raise the normal rate of
Mindtree Ltd.
42,000
168
Equity Div ( @ 9 % )26
Retained profit
- 72,000
86000
Retained profit is less than 50 % of profit. Lower retained profit means lower
growth in future ( Remember that Gordon has told that growth depends upon two
factors . retained profit is one of those two factors.) It is a negative feature of the
Mindtree Ltd. as compared of industry. It should result in reduction of value of
Mindtree Ltd. For this purpose, we should raise the normal rate of Mindtree Ltd.
Question No. 14
Following are the information relating to a manufacturing company:
Year
1975-76
20,00,000
3,00,000
1976-77
22,50,000
3,70,000
1977-78
23,00,000
3,75,000
1978-79
24,00,000
4,00,000
(a) Average net worth does not include investments worth Rs. 3,00,000 (at
market value) on the valuation date, the yield in respect of which has
been excluded in computing the adjusted tax profits figures.
(b) The company has Rs. 9,00,000 on equity shares of Rs. 100 each and Rs.
4,00,000 in 9 per cent preference shares of Rs. 100 each.
(c) It is the usual practice of similar type of companies to set aside 20 per
cent of the taxed profits for rehabilitation purposes.
(d) On the valuation day, the net worth (including investments) amounted to
Rs. 25,50,000.
(e) The normal expected rate of return is 10 per cent.
(f) The company has paid dividends regularly within a range of 9 per cent to
11 per cent on equity shares over the past 6 years and expects to
maintain the same.
26
Industry retains 50% of profit after paying 9 % dividend. Hence, to find whether Tee
retains 50% profit or not, we should consider 9 % equity dividend i.e. we should find
whether Tee Ltd can retain 50% profit after paying 9% dividend ( which is industry mark ).
( Industrys 50 % bench mark is based on 9 % equity dividend and not on 12 %
dividend ). If Tee does not retain 50% profit on the basis of 9% dividend, it a negative
point for Tee; if it does not retain 50% on the basis of 12 %, it not a negative point.
169
Find out the value of equity shares on the basis of productivity. You may use
weight factor: 1, 2, 3, 4 for four years, assigning weight 1 to the year 1975-76 and
so on.
Answer : The main point of this question is that we have to find the value of share
on some date ( which has been referred in the question as valuation date ), and
not on the B/S date. For 1978-79, average CE ( average net worth )was
24,00,000 ( exclusive of investment amount ) , adjusted taxed profit for the year
was 400000, it means CE ( net worth )on 31.3.1979 was more than 24,00,000.
On the date on which we have to find the value of the share ( which has been
referred in the question as valuation date ), the net worth exclusive of investment
is Rs.22,50,000 ( net worth inclusive of investments 25,50,000; amount of
investments 300000; hence net worth exclusive of investments 2250000).
Year
Rate of return
75-76
76-77
77-78
78-79
B
Rs.
10,00,000
20,00,000
40,00,000
Assume market expectation 15 per cent and that 80 per cent of profits are
distributed.
170
Q. No.16 :The B/S of RNR limited as on 31st De. 1999 as follows(Rs. Lakhs)
Liabilities
Assets
Goodwill
10
FA
15
written off )
Total
30
Total
30
Fixed assets are worth Rs. 24 Lakhs. Other tangible assets are revalued at Rs. 3
Lakhs. The company is expected to settle the disputed bonus claim of Rs. 1
Lakhs not provided for in the accounts. Goodwill appearing in the Balance Sheet
is purchased goodwill. It is considered reasonable to increase the value of
goodwill by an amount equal to average of the book value and a valuation made
at 3 years purchase of average super-profit for the last 4 years. Tax 50%.
After tax profits and dividend rates were as follows :
Year
Dividend %
1996
3.00
11
1997
3.50
12
1998
4.00
13
1999
4.10
14
171
Akbar holds 20,000 equity shares of Rs. 10 each fully paid and 10,000 equity
shares of Rs.6 each fully paid . He wants to sell away his holdings.
(i) Determine the break-up value27 and market value of both kinds of shares
(ii) what should be the fair value of shares, if controlling interest is being sold ?
Hint : Assumption Dividends referred in the question are proposed dividends.
The amount of proposed dividend for the year 1999 is included in the amount of
liabilities ( Rs. 10 Lakhs ) appearing in the B/S.
WINDING UP
FORMATION
AMALGAMATION
TWO OR MORE
ONE
ABSORPTION
ONE OR MORE
NO NEW FORMATION
E. Reconstruction
One
One
Intrinsic value
172
Before passing the entries, we should calculate the purchase consideration
(PC). PC is the amount paid by purchasing company to the liquidator of vendor
company for shareholders of vender company. There are two methods of
calculating P.C. (i) Net payment method, and (ii) Net assets method. Under net
payment method, PC is the sum of Cash and agreed value of shares,
debentures and other assets given by purchasing company to the liquidator of
vendor company for shareholders of vendor company. Under net assets method,
PC is equal to agreed value of assets (including goodwill) taken over minus
agreed value of liabilities taken over.
Two important points about liabilities of vendor company (i) If a liability of
vendor company is discharged by purchasing company, then first it should be
taken over by purchasing company and then it should be directly discharged by
purchasing company. (It should not be paid through liquidator). (ii) Inter-company
Owings, i.e., liabilities of vendor company which are assets of purchasing
company, should be taken over by purchasing company and then these are
cancelled against corresponding assets of purchasing company.
Steps for Realization account (books of vendor company):
1. Transfer all real assets (except cash and bank) to the Dr. side of realization a/c at their
book values whether taken over by purchasing company or not.
2. Transfer that amount of cash and bank which is taken over by purchasing
company to the Dr. side of realisation a/c.
3. Transfer all outside liabilities to the credit side of realisation a/c at their
book values whether taken over or not.
4. For assets and liabilities taken over by purchasing company, debit the
purchasing company account by crediting the realisation account with the
amount of purchase consideration (Purchasing company a/c Dr. to
realisation a/c).
5. Sometimes, a liability is satisfied by transfer of an existing non-cash and
bank asset of vendor company (existing non-cash and bank asset of
vendor company implies (i) The asset has not been received as part of PC,
and (ii) It is other than cash and bank). No entry is passed in this situation.
But if the liability is not fully satisfied and some cash is also paid, the entry
should be passed for cash paid, i.e., realisation a/c should be debited and
cash a/c should be credited with amount of cash paid. If the asset is valued
at an amount higher than that of liability, some cash may be received. The
entry for such receipt should be passed, i.e., cash a/c should be debited
and realisation a/c should be credited with the amount of cash received.
6. For other assets (neither taken over by purchasing company, nor
transferred in favour of liabilities): (a) If sold, cash a/c should be debited
and realisation a/c should be credited, (b) If transferred to shareholders,
shareholders a/c should be debited are realisation a/c should be credited
with current value of such assets.
7. For other liabilities (i.e., liabilities which are neither taken over by
purchasing company nor satisfied through transfer to existing non-cash and
173
bank asset of vendor company) (A) If paid for Dr. realisation a/c and credit
concerned payment account. Concerned payment a/c may be cash or
bank, (B) If transferred to shareholders: Dr. realisation a/c and Cr.
shareholders a/c.
8. For realisation expenses paid by vendor company, Dr. realisation a/c and
Cr. cash a/c.
9. Profit/loss on realisation should be transferred to sundry shareholders a/c.
Realisation expenses/winding up expenses of vendor company paid by
purchasing company
(a) Purchasing company should debit goodwill a/c and credit cash/bank a/c.
(b) No entry in the books of vendor company.
VENDER COMPANY HOLDS SHARES OF PURCHASING COMPANY
Net Assets Method
Find PC for assets and liabilities taken over, as the purchasing company cannot
take over its own shares, such shares should not be considered for calculation of
PC. Such shares should be transferred to shareholders of vendor company
through realisation a/c.
Net Payment Method
(a) Find PC that would have been there if purchasing company would have
purchased its own shares also. (We do not consider this PC for recording
the transactions in the books of accounts, it is not correct amount of PC as it
is based on wrong assumption that the purchasing company takes over its
own shares).
(b) As purchasing company cannot take over its own shares, the amount
calculated above should be reduced by No. of shares of purchasing
company held by vendor company multiplied by agreed value of each such
share. The resultant figure is PC for the assets and liabilities taken over.
PURCHASING COMPANY HOLDS SHARES OF VENDOR COMPANY
Find PC ignoring the fact that purchasing company holds shares of vendor
company. This is the PC for the business taken over. The purchasing company
wont have to pay full amount of this PC as it is already part owner of the
business. Hence, PC is reduced by the amount which the purchasing company is
entitled to get as shareholder of vendor company.
BOTH COMPANIES HOLD SHARES OF EACH OTHER
Net Assets Method
(i) Find value of both businesses with the help of simultaneous equations.
(ii) Find PC for assets and liabilities taken over only. As purchasing company
cannot take over its own shares, such shares should not be considered for
PC.
174
(iii) Purchasing company wont pay the full amount of PC calculated above.
Hence, the PC calculated above should be reduced by the amount
receivable by the purchasing company in the capacity of shareholders of
vendor company. The resultant figure is the amount of PC payable by
purchasing company to the liquidator of vendor company
Net Payment Methods
(a) Find PC that would have been there if purchasing company would have
purchased its own shares also. While finding out this amount we ignore that
fact that purchasing company holds shares of vendor company. (We do not
consider this PC for recording the transactions in the books of accounts. It is
not correct amount of PC as it is based on wrong assumption that the
purchasing company takes over its own shares).
(b) As purchasing company cannot take over its own shares, the amount
calculated above should be reduced by No. of shares of purchasing
company held by vendor company multiplied by agreed value of such share.
The resultant figure is PC for assets and liabilities taken over.
(c) Purchasing company wont pay the full amount of PC calculated above.
Hence, the PC calculated above should be reduced by the amount
receivable by purchasing company in the capacity of shareholder of vendor
company. The resultant figure is the amount of PC payable by purchasing
company to the liquidator of vendor company.
Internal Reconstruction
In this case there is no winding up no new formation no sale of business no
purchase of business. The assets and liabilities are revalued through capital
reduction A/c. P&L A/c Dr. balance and fictitious assets must be written off
against capital reduction a/c even if the question is silent on this point. If the final
balance in capital reduction a/c is debit it should be transferred to goodwill a/c, if
there is credit balance it should be transferred to capital reserve account.
Question No. 1
White Ltd. agreed to acquire the business of Green Ltd. as on December 31,
1975. The summarized balance sheet of Green Ltd. on that date was as follows:
Liabilities
E. Share capital
(Rs. 10 each)
General Reserve
P&L Account
6% Debentures
Creditors
Rs.
6,00,000
1,70,000
1,10,000
1,00,000
20,000
10,00,000
Assets
Rs.
Goodwill
1,00,000
Land Build& Plant 6,40,000
Stock-in-Trade
1,68,000
Debtors
36,000
Cash
56,000
10,00,000
175
1. A cash payment equivalent to Rs. 2.50 for every Rs. 10 share in Green Ltd.
2. The issue of such an amount of fully paid 5 per cent debentures of White
Ltd. at 96 per cent as is sufficient to discharge the 6 per cent debentures of
Green Ltd. at a premium of 20 per cent.
3. The issue of 90,000 Rs. 10 shares, fully paid, in White Ltd. having an agree
value of Rs. 15 per share.
When computing the agreed consideration, the directors of White Ltd. valued
the land, building and plant at Rs. 12,00,000, the stock-in-trade at Rs. 1,42,000
and the debtors at their face value subject to an allowance of 5 per cent to cover
doubtful debts. The cost of liquidation (met by White) of Green Ltd. comes to Rs.
5,000. Close the books of Green Ltd. and draft journal entries required in the
books of White Ltd.
Ans.
Realization a/c
Goodwill
1,00,000
Creditors
Land Building
6,40,000
Deb.
Stock
1,68,000
White Ltd.
15,00,000
Total
16,20,000
Drs.
56,000
6,20,000
Total
16,20,000
Total
1,00,000
36,000
Cash
Shareholders a/c ( Profit on
realization )
Bank
Shares of white
20,000
Shareholders a/c
150000
ESC
1350000
G.R.
P&L
Realisation a/c (profit)
1500000
Total
Question No. 2
The following is the balance sheet of Weak Ltd. as on June 30, 1976 :
Liabilities
Share Capital :
Rs.
Assets
Goodwill
Rs.
35,000
600000
170000
110000
620000
1500000
176
( Rs. 100 each)
2,00,000
Reserve Fund
20,000
5% Debentures
1,00,000
Loan from A (a director) 40,000
Sundry Creditors
80,000
4,40,000
4,40,000
The business of the company is taken over by Strong Ltd. as on the date, on
the following terms :
(a) Strong Ltd. to take over all assets except cash, to value the assets at their
book value less 10 per cent except goodwill which was to be valued at 4
years purchase of the excess of average (five years) profits over 8 per cent
of the combined amount of share capital and reserves;
(b) Strong Ltd. to take over trade creditors which were subject to a discount of
five per cent. Other outside liabilities were discharged by Strong Ltd. at
their book values.
(c) The purchase consideration was to be discharged in cash to the extent of
Rs. 10,000 and the balance in fully paid equity shares of Rs. 10 each
valued at Rs. 12.50 per share.
The average of the five years profits was Rs. 30,100. The expenses of
liquidation amounted to Rs. 4,000. Weak Ltd. had sold prior to 30th June, 1976,
goods costing Rs. 30,000 to Strong Ltd. for Rs. 40,000. Debtors include
Rs. 20,000 still due from Strong Ltd. on the date of absorption, Rs. 25,000 worth
of the goods were still in stocks of Strong Ltd. Show the important ledger
accounts in the books of Weak Ltd. and Journal entries in the books of Strong
Ltd.
Ans,
Goodwill
L&B
P&M
Stock
Drs.
Cash ( exp. )
Total
Realization a/c
35,000 Crs.
85,000 Loan
1,60,000 Deb.
55,000 Strong Ltd.
65,000 Shareholders a/c (loss)
4,000
4,04,000 Total
80,000
40,000
1,00,000
1,62,500
21,500
4,04,000
Shareholders a/c
Dis. On Deb.
6000
ESC
200000
177
Realization a/c
21500
40000
Shares of strong
152500
Total
220000
Res.
20000
Total
220000
Question No. 3
B Co. Ltd. had the following Balance Sheet as on 31st March 1978. (Rs.)
Share Capital
Fixed Assets
83,00,000
(Rs. 100 each)
50,00,000 Current Assets 69,00,000
Capital Reserve
8,00,000 Investments
17,00,000
General Reserve
36,00,000 Goodwill
2,00,000
Unsecured Loans
22,00,000
Sundry Creditors
42,00,000
Provision for Taxation11,00,000
Proposed Dividend
2,00,000
171,00,000
171,00,000
B. Co. Ltd. is amalgamated with Beesons Ltd. as on 31st March, 1978, on
which date the balance sheet of Beesons Ltd. as follows :
Beesons Ltd.
Liabilities
Share Capital
(Rs. 10 each)
General Reserves
Secured Loans
Sundry Creditors
Provision for Tax
Proposed Dividend
Rs.
Assets
Rs.
328,00,000
328,00,000
For the purpose of the amalgamation the goodwill of B. Co. Ltd. was considered valueless. There are also arrears of depreciation in B. Co. Ltd.
amounting to Rs. 4,00,000. The shareholders in B. Co. Ltd. are allotted, in full
satisfaction of their claims, shares in Beesons in the same proportion as the
respective intrinsic values of shares of two companies bear to one another. Pass
Journal entires in the books of both the companies to give effect to the above.
Ans.
Books of B co Ltd.
Realization a/c
178
FA
8300000
Loan
2200000
CA
6900000
Crs.
4200000
Invest.
1700000
Tax
1100000
Beesons
9000000
Goodwill
200000
600000
17100000 Total
17100000
Shareholders a/c
Realisation a/c (Loss )
Shares of Beesons
600000
9000000
ESC
5000000
CR
800000
GR
3600000
Prop. Dividend
Total
9600000
200000
Total
9600000
Question No. 4
The following are the balance sheets of A Ltd. and B Ltd. as on 31.12.1979.
A Ltd.
Liabilities
Rs.
210,00,000
Liabilities
Rs.
Assets
Rs.
Fixed Assets
Stocks
(Pledged with secured
Loan holders)
Other Current Assets
Profit & Loss A/c
17,00,000
92,00,000
18,00,000
83,00,000
210,00,000
B Ltd.
Assets
Rs.
34,00,000
48,00,000
179
Current Liabilities
23,00,000
82,00,000
82,00,000
The two companies go into liquidation and C Ltd. is formed to taken over their
business. The following information is given :
(a) All the current assets of the two companies except pledged stock are taken
over by C Ltd. The realizable value of all current assets are 80 per cent of
book values in case of A Ltd. and 70 per cent for B Ltd.
(b) The break-up of current liabilities is as follows:
A Ltd.
B Ltd.
Statutory Liabilities (including Rs. 11,00,000
in case of A Ltd. in respect of a claim not
having been admitted shown as contingent
liability)
36,00,000
5,00,000
Liability of Employees
15,00,000
9,00,000
(c) Secured loans include Rs. 8,00,000 accrued interest in the case of B Ltd.
(d) 1,00,000 equity shares of Rs. 10 each are allotted at par against cash
payment of entire face value by C Ltd. to the shareholders of A Ltd. and B
Ltd. in the ratio of face values of shares held by them in A Ltd. and B Ltd.
(e) Preference shareholders are issued equity shares worth Rs. 1,00,000 in
lieu of present holdings.
(f) Secured loan holders agree to continue the balance amount of their loans
to C Ltd. after adjusting value of pledged security in case of A Ltd. and after
waiving 50 per cent of interest due in case of B Ltd.
(g) Unsecured loans are taken over by C Ltd. at 25 per cent of loan amounts.
(h) Employees are issued fully paid up equity shares in C Ltd. at par in full
settlement of entire dues.
(i) Statutory liabilities are taken over by C Ltd. at full value and miscellaneous
creditors are taken over at 80 per cent of the book value.
Show the opening balance sheet of C Ltd.
Ans.
Books of A Ltd.
Realization a/c
FA
17,00,000
CL
Stock
92,00,000
Loan
CA
18,00,000
Loan
Shareholders a/c (profit ) 62,00,000
C Ltd
Total
1,89,00,000 Total
Shareholders a/c
P & L A/C
83,00,000
ESC
65,00,000
43,00,000
80,00,000
1,00,000
1,89,00,000
15,00,000
180
Esc
1,00,000
Total
84,00,000
PSC
GR
Real. a/c ( profit )
Total
5,00,000
2,00,000
62,00,000
84,00,000
Question No. 5
The Balance Sheet of X Ltd. and Y Ltd. as on 31.3.1977 are as below :
Balance Sheet as on 31.3.1977
Liabilities
Assets
Equity Shares
Fixed Assets
Capital
Other than
(Rs. 10) 5,00,000 3,00,000 Goodwill 3,00,000
Reserve
40,000 20,000 Stock
80,000
P&L A/c
60,000 40,000 Debtors 1,40,000
Sundry
Bank
1,20,000
Creditors
50,000 30,000 Preliminary
Expenses 10,000
6,50,000 3,90,000
6,50,000
2,00,000
60,000
90,000
35,000
5,000
3,90,000
P. Exp.
Shares of X Ltd.
Shareholders a/c
5000
ESC
375000
Res.
300000
20000
181
Total
380000
P & L a/c
Realization a/c (Profit )
Total
30000
30000
380000
Question No. 6
The summarised balance sheets of PQ Ltd. and XY Ltd. at 31st December, 1988.
PQ Ltd.
Authorised Capital :
7 % cum. preference share of 1
6% cum. preference shares of 1
Ordinary shares of 0.25
Issued Capital :
7% cumulative preference shares of
1 fully paid
6% cumulative preference shares of
1 fully paid
Ordinary shares of 0.25
Profit and loss account balance
6% Debentures
Trade Creditors
Bank overdraft (secured)
Provision for doubtful debts (including
3,000 for PQ Ltd.)
XY Ltd.
1,50,000
25,000
1,50,000 2,00,000
1,00,000
25,000
1,00,000 1,50,000
15,400
40,000
39,000
37,000
24,000
4,000
182
2,28,000 3,06,400
Fixed Assets at cost less depreciation
Buildings
54,000
61,000
Plant & Machinery
29,000 83,000
73,000 1,34,000
Goodwill
20,000
15,000
Investments :
50,000 shares of 1
in MN Ltd. at cost
40,500
Rs.9,550 6% Debentures in
PQ Ltd. at cost
9,100
Current Assets:
Stocks
31,000
28,900
Debtors
21,500
77,400
Balance at Bank
52,500
42,000 1,48,300
Profit and Loss account bal. 32,000
2,28,000
3,06,400
PQ Ltd. owed XY Ltd. 9,000 on current trading and this is included in the
debtors and creditors of the respective companies.
The necessary meetings of debenture holders, creditors and members having
been held, it was agreed that PQ Ltd. should cease trading at 31st December
and go into liquidation on 3rd January, 1989 and XY Ltd. should take over the
assets and liabilities of PQ Ltd. on the following terms and taking into account the
following factors:
1. On 2nd January, 1989 PQ Ltd. paid into its bank account the following
sums :
60,000
15,000
19,000
100
At book value
183
5. The debentures of PQ Ltd. (other than those held by XY Ltd. which were to
be cancelled) were to be satisfied by an issue of 7 per cent debentures in
XY Ltd. which were to be issued at an agreed value of 102.
6. PQ Ltd.s debt of 9,000 to XY Ltd. was to be cancelled.
7. In settlement of each 1 of their claim the creditors of PQ Ltd. were to
receive an immediate allotment of two ordinary shares of 0.25 fully paid
in XY Ltd., followed by 0.'3 cash, the latter to be paid by XY Ltd. on 1st
February, 1989.
8. Preference shareholders in PQ Ltd. were to receive two 7 per cent
cumulative preference shares of XY Ltd. for each five shares of their
present holding.
9. Ordinary shareholders in PQ Ltd. were to receive one ordinary share in XY
Ltd. for every fifty shares of their present holding.
You are required to prepare : (i) Ledger accounts of vendor company,
(ii) Journal of purchasing company.
Ans.
Books pf PQ
Realization a/c
Building
54000
Bank Overdraft
21200
P.& M.
29000
Creditors
39000
Goodwill
20000
Deb.
40000
Investment
40500
XY Ltd. (
consideration )
Stock
31000
Shareholders a/c(Loss )
75400
Drs.
19000
Total
193500
Total
193500
Purchase 17900
Shareholders a/c
P & L a/c
(32000- 300 bad debts
recovered )
31700
Pref. shares of XY
10000
ESC
100000
PSC
25000
184
E. shares of XY
7900
Realization a/c
75400
Total
125000
Total
125000
Question No. 7
A Ltd. and B Ltd. both incorporated on 1.1.1981 decided to amalgamate. Holding
company C Ltd. is formed on 1.1.1983 to acquire all the shares of both
companies. From the information given below, prepare balance sheet of C Ltd.
after acquiring all shares. Both A Ltd. and B Ltd. are engaged in similar business
activities.
1.
The shares of the two companies were acquired on the following terms:
(a) Rs. 100, 12 per cent debenture for every Rs. 100, of net assets owned by
each company on 31st December, 1982, and
(b) Rs. 100 equity shares based on two years purchase of profit before
taxation. The profits are to be average profits of 1981 and 1982 being
weighted on 1 : 2 basis.
2.
3.
It was agreed that accounts of B Ltd., for the two years ended December 31,
1982 be adjusted, where necessary, to confirm with accounting policies
followed by A Ltd.
The pre-tax profits, included investment income, of the two companies were
as follows:
1981
1982
5,46,000 6,12,000
5,96,000 8,58,000
A Ltd.
B Ltd.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Liabilities
Share Capital
1981
Rs.
1982
Rs.
Assets
Fixed Assets
1981
Rs.
1982
Rs.
185
Issued & Subscribed
5000 equity shares
of Rs. 100 each
fully paid
5,00,000
Revenue
Reserve
2,86,000
Sundry
Creditors
4,90,000
Bank overdraft
Provision for
taxation
3,10,000
5,00,000
7,14,000
4,94,000
1,70,000
4,30,000
15,86,000 23,08,000
Cost
3,20,000 3,20,000
Less: Depreciation
48,000 96,000
2,72,000 2,24,000
Investments
(Market value
4,90,000)
4,00,000
Current Assets:
Stock-in-trade
in cost
5,97,000 7,42,000
Sundry
Debtors 5,94,000 8,91,000
Prepaid Exp. 72,000 48,000
Cash at Bank 51,000
3,000
15,86,000 23,08,000
aaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaaa
A Limited
Liabilities
1981
Rs.
1982
Rs.
Assets
1981
Rs.
1982
Rs.
Share Capital
(Rs. 100)
4,00,000
Capital Reserve
Revenue
Reserve
2,66,100
Creditors
5,00,900
Taxation
2,80,000
x 2 = 1180000
186
[(546000 x 1) + ( 885000 x 2 )]
Bs goodwill = -----------------------------------------
x 2 = 1544000
3
Goodwill
Net assets
Total
11,80,000
10,28,000
22,08,000
15,44,000
12,81,000
28,25,000
Total
27,24,000
23,09,000
50,33,000
2724000
Investment in
shares of A Ltd.
2208000
Deb.
2309000
Investment in
shares of B Ltd.
28,25,000
Total
50,33,000
Total
50,33,000
Question No. 8
Following are the balance sheets of two companies, Wye Ltd. and Zee Ltd. as at
December 31, 1965.
Wye Ltd. Zee Ltd.
Rs.
Rs.
Creditors
1,50,000 95,000 1,000 shares in
Reserve
1,00,000 55,000 Wye Ltd.
Share Capital
Sundry Assets
(Rs. 100 )
5,00,000 3,00,000
7,50,000 4,50,000
Wye Ltd.
Rs.
Zee Ltd.
Rs.
7,50,000
1,00,000
3,50,000
7,50,000
4,50,000
(a) Wye Ltd. absorbed Zee Ltd. on the basis of intrinsic value of shares.(b)
What will be your answer if, all other facts remaining unchanged, entries are to
be made at par.
Ans (a) PC = 350000-95000 = 255000
Intrinsic value of share of Wye = (750000 -150000)/5000 = Rs.120
No. of shares of Wye to be issued = 255000 / 120 = 2125
Journal of Wye
Dr. 255000
187
To Liquidator of Zee
S. assets a/c
To Cr.
To Business purchase
Dr.350000
95000
255000
Liquidator a/c
To ESC
To Sec. Premium a/c
Dr. 255000
212500
42500
Books of Zee
S. assets
Investment
Shareholders a/c ( profit )
Total
Realization a/c
350000
Crs.
100000
Wye
20000
Shareholders a/c (1000
shares of Wye)
470000
Total
Shareholders a/c
120000
ESC
375000
Reserve
Realisation a/c ( profit)
Total
95000
255000
120000
470000
300000
55000
20000
375000
188
Business purchase a/c
To Liquidator of Zee
Dr. 212500
S. assets a/c
To Cr.
To Business purchase
To Cap. Reserve
Dr.350000
95000
212500
42500
Liquidator a/c
To ESC
Dr. 212500
212500
Books of Zee
Realization a/c
350000
Crs.
100000
Wye
Shareholders a/c (1000
shares of Wye)
Shareholders a/c ( Loss)
450000
Total
S. assets
Investment
Total
95000
212500
100000
42500
450000
Shareholders a/c
100000
ESC
300000
Reserve
55000
Total
355000
Question No. 9
Balance sheets of X Ltd. and Y Ltd. as on 31.12.1987 are given below:
X
Share Capital
(Rs. 10 each) 4,00,000 2,00,000
9% Debentures
1,00,000
Reserve
1,00,000 40,000
Creditors
1,00,000 50,000
6,00,000
3,90,000
X
S .Assets
5,000 shares
of X Ltd.
6,00,000
6,00,000
Y
3,40,000
50,000
3,90,000
189
X Ltd. to take over Y Ltd. on the following terms (a) For each share of
Y Ltd., X Ltd. will issue its one share of Rs. 10 at Rs. 11 and pay cash 50 paise,
(b) X Ltd. to issue such an amount of fully paid 10 per cent debentures at 90 as it
sufficient to discharge 9 per cent debentures of Y Ltd. at a premium of 8 per cent.
Give Journal of X. Also give Realization account and Shareholders A/c in the
books of Y Ltd.
Question No. 10
A Ltd. has acquired, as a current asset, 60,000 shares in B Ltd. for Rs. 60,000 on
1st November, 1964. On 1st January, 1966 it agreed to absorb B Ltd. the
consideration being :
(i) The assumption of its liabilities;
(ii) The discharge of the Rs. 40,000 debentures held outside the company at a
premium of 10 per cent by the issue of 6 per cent. Debentures in A Ltd.
carrying a full six months interest payable 1st July, 1966;
(iii) A payment in case of Re. 0.50 per share in B Ltd.; and
(iv) The issue of shares of Re. 1 each in A Ltd. credited as fully paid to the
members of B Ltd. on the basis of:
Two equity shares (valued at Rs. 1.60 each) and one 7 cumulative
preference share (valued at Rs. 1.10) for every five shares in B Ltd.
The summarized balance sheet of B Ltd. as on 31st December, 1965 was as
follows:
Rs.
Share Capital:
1,60,000 shares of Re. 1
each Re. 0.75 paid 1,20,000
General Reserve
75,000
Profit & Loss A/c
21,550
Insurance Funds*
10,000
5% Debentures
45,000
Creditors
17,800
Rs.
Fixed Assets
Stocks
Debtors
Investments:
On account of
Insurance Fund
General Rs. 5000
5% Debentures
in B Ltd.
Bank Balance
Goodwill
73,000
85,800
45,000
10,000
4,800
50,750
20,000
2,89,350
2,89,350
* The company had been carrying its own insurance risk crediting amounts
equivalent to premium to the fund and charging losses thereof.
It was agreed that for absorption purposes, 5 per cent should be written off
stocks and provision of 2 per cent made for doubtful debts. The remaining
assets, other than goodwill, are considered to be properly valued for the purpose
of absorption.
190
Before passing entries in respect of the absorption, A Ltd. decided to revalue
shares in B Ltd. on the same basis as that of the absorption.
The absorption was completed on 1st March, 1966 by the issue of necessary
shares and debentures in A Ltd. and payment of cash B Ltd. was thereupon
wound up. Expenses amounted to Rs. 750 and were paid by A Ltd. Prepare
Ledger of B and Journal of A.
Question No. 11
Assuming the Strong Ltd. purchased 10 per cent shares of Weak Ltd. for
Rs. 18,000 sometime before it took over the business of Weak Ltd. revise your
answer to Q. No. 2.
Question No. 12
The following balance sheets are given as on 31st March, 1976:
(Rs. in lakhs)
Best
Ltd.
Share Capital
Share of Rs.100
each fully paid 20
Reserve &
Surpluses
10
Liabilities
20
50
Better
Ltd.
Best
Ltd.
Better
Ltd.
Fixed Assets
25
Investment
5
10 Current Assets 20
15
8
2
20
20
50
191
(c) It was agreed that Best Ltd. will take over the business of Better Ltd., on
the basis of the Betters balance sheet, the consideration taking the form of
allotment of Shares in Best Ltd.
(d) The value of the shares in Best Ltd. was considered to be Rs. 150, and the
shares in Better Ltd., were valued at Rs. 100 after the issue of the bonus
shares. The allotment of shares is to be made on the basis of these values.
(e) Liabilities of Better Ltd., included Rs. 1 lakh due to Best Ltd. for purchase
from it, on which Best Ltd. made a profit of 25 per cent on the cost. Rs.
50,000 out of the said purchases, remained in stock on the date of the
above balance sheet.
Make the closing ledger entries in the books of Better Ltd. and the opening
journal entries in the books of Best Ltd. and prepare the balance sheet as at 1st
April, 1976, after the take over.
Ans.
Journal of Best
Business Purchase a/c
Dr. 1500000
To Liquidator of Better
Liquidator of Better
Dr. 1500000
To Investment a/c300000
To ESC
800000
To S. Prem. 400000
FA Dr. 1500000
CADr. 500000
To Liabilities
200000
To Business purchase .1500000
To Capital reserve .300000
Liabilities a/c .Dr.100000
To CA
..100000
Capital reserve a/c ..Dr.10000
To Stock.10000
Books of Better
192
FA
CA
1500000
500000
Total
2000000
Realisation a/c
Total
Realization A/c
Liabilities
Best Ltd
Shareholders a/c
(Loss )
Total
Best Ltd.
E. shares of Best
Shareholders a/c
Total
1500000
1500000
Realization a/c
Best Ltd
To E. Shares of
Best
Total
300000
300000
1200000
Shareholders a/c
ESC
Reserve &Surplus
1800000
Total
200000
1500000
300000
2000000
1200000
300000
1500000
1500000
300000
1800000
Question No. 13
Following are the summarised balance sheets of two companies P Ltd. and N
Ltd. as on 31st December, 1975:
Balance Sheet of P Ltd. and N Ltd. as on 31.12.1975
Liabilities
P Ltd.
Rs.
N Ltd.
Rs.
Share capital:
(Shares of
Rs. 10 each) 5,00,000 1,80,000
Reserves
1,45,000
Debentures
2,00,000
Trade
Creditors
3,00,0002,00,000
9,45,000 5,80,000
Assets
P Ltd.
Rs.
Shares in P
Ltd. (10,000)
Shares in N
Ltd. (4,500) 30,000
Debentures in
N Ltd. 1,00,000
Sundry Assets 8,15,000
P&L A/c
9,45,000
N. Ltd.
Rs.
1,00,000
4,60,000
20,000
5,80,000
The two companies agreed that P should take over N Ltd. The debenture
holders in N Ltd. agreed to convert the debentures into 9 per cent redeemable
preference shares of Rs. 100 each. Prior to the absorption P Ltd. declared a
193
dividend of 20 per cent the dividend had not yet been paid. Shareholders in N
Ltd. were to receive share in P Ltd. on the basis of the intrinsic value of the
shares. The sundry assets of N Ltd. had to be written up by Rs. 40,000 and those
of P Ltd. reduced by Rs. 15,000. Prepare Ledger of N and Journal of P.
Question No. 14
The following are the balance sheets of A Ltd. and B Ltd. as on 31.12.1987:
Liabilities
ESC (Rs. 10)
10% PSC
(Rs. 100)
Reserves &
Surplus
12% Deb.
Creditors
B/P
5,00,000 2,00,000
Assets
1,00,000 1,00,000
Stock
3,00,000
3,40,000 1,60,000
Debtors
1,60,000
20,000 20,000
B/R 50,000
Bank 90,000
12,60,000 7,30,000
12,60,000
B
3,50,000
80,000
1,70,000
90,000
10,000
30,000
7,30,000
Fixed assets of both companies are to be revalued at 20 per cent above book
value. Both companies pay 10 per cent equity dividend, preference dividend
having already been paid.
After the above transactions are given effect to, A Ltd. will absorb B Ltd. on
the basis of following terms:
1. 6 equity shares of Rs. 10 will be issued by A Ltd. at par against 5 shares of
B Ltd.
2. 10 per cent preference shareholders of B Ltd. will be paid at 10 per cent
discount by issue of 11 per cent preference shares of Rs. 100 each at par
in A Ltd.
3. Rs. 20,000 is to be paid by A Ltd. to B Ltd. for liquidation expenses.
Bills receivable discounted by A Ltd. were all accepted by B Ltd. Creditors of
B Ltd. include Rs. 30,000 due to A Ltd.
Give Journal of A Ltd. Also give Equity shareholders A/c, A Ltd. A/c and
Realisation A/c in the books of B Ltd.
Ans.
Fixed Assets a/c
To Cap. Reserve
Capital Reserve a/c
Journal of A
Dr. 120000
Dr. 12000
194
To Investment a/c
12000
P & L a/c
Dr. 50000
To Dividend Declared a/c
Dividend declared a/c Dr. 50000
To Bank
Bank a/c
To Dividend
Dividend a/c
To P & L a/c
Dr. 4000
Dr. 4000
FA a/c
Dr. 420000
Stock a/c
Dr.170000
Drs. a/c
Dr. 90000
B/R a/c
Dr. 10000
Bank a/c
Dr. 13000
To Debentures
100000
To Crs.
160000
To Bills payable
20000
To Capital Reserve 123000
To Business purchase 3,00,000
Crs. a/c..Dr. 30000
To Drs. a/c
Goodwill a/c
To bank
FA
Stock
Drs.
Dr 20000
Books of B Ltd
Realization a/c
420000
B/P
170000
Crs.
90000
Deb.
20000
160000
100000
195
B/R
Bank
Investment
TOTAL
To Realization a/c
Total
P. shares of A Ltd
Equity shareholders a/c
Total
A Ltd.
E. shares of A Ltd (
16200 E. shares of A)
Realization a/c (3000 E.
shares of A)
Realization a/c (loss)
Total
* R& S ( given in B/S)
Div. paid
Div, Received
Revaluation of
10000
13000
80000
783000
A Ltd.
Shareholders a/c( 3000
shares of A Ltd. )
Shareholders a/c ( Loss)
Total
A Ltd.s a/c
300000
E. Shareholders
E . shares of A Ltd
P. shares of A Ltd
300000
Total
Pref. shareholders a/c
90000
PSC
10000
100000
Total
300000
30000
173000
783000
48000
162000
90000
300000
100000
100000
E. Shareholders a/c
48000
ESC
162000
R & S*
200000
203000
30000
10000
173000
413000
Total
413000
150000
-20000
+3000
+70000
203000
Question No. 15
Gloria and Swanson Ltd. had to pass the hands of a receiver for debenture
holders who held charge on all assets except uncalled capital. The following is
the position as prepared by the receiver:
196
Rs.
Share Capital
20,000 shares of Rs. 50 each fully paid up
1,00,000 shares of Rs. 50 each, Rs. 25
per share paid up
First Debentures
Second Debentures
Unsecured Creditors
Bank Balance
Building, Plant and Machinery (estimated to
realise Rs. 15,00,000)
10,00,000
25,00,000
25,00,000
50,00,000
40,00,000
30,00,000
40,00,000
First Debentures
Second Debentures
Unsecured Creditors
Gloria
Rs.
20,00,000
30,00,000
6,00,000
56,00,000
Swanson
Rs.
5,00,000
20,00,000
9,00,000
34,00,000
Share Capital:
Fully paid shares
5,00,000
5,00,000
Partly paid shares
10,00,000 10,00,000
The following scheme of reconstruction is proposed:
1. Gloria is to cancel Rs. 31,00,000 of his total debt, pay cash Rs. 5,00,000
and he would be issued Rs. 30,00,000 first debentures in lieu of first and
second debentures to be cancelled.
2. (a) Swanson is to cancel his total debt by accepting Rs. 5,00,000 in cash
and Rs. 5,00,000 in first debentures.
(b) Swanson is to surrender for cancellation Rs. 5,00,000 worth of fully paid
up shares.
3. Unsecured creditors, other than Gloria and Swanson, agree to reduce their
debt by 20 per cent and accept in lieu thereof, 1,00,000 shares of
Rs. 10 each fully paid up and the balance in cash payable in five equal
annual installments.
4. Uncalled capital is to be called up in full and Rs. 40 per share to be
cancelled, thus marking all shares of Rs. 10 each.
Assuming the scheme is duly approved by all parties interested and by the
court, show the reconstructed. Balance sheet and the journal entries in the books
of the company.
Question No. 16
197
Balance sheet of Rundown Ltd. as on 31.12.1993.
Liabilities
Rs.
10,10,000
Assets
Goodwill
Plant
Loose Tools
Debtors
Stocks
Cash
Bank
Preliminary Exp.
Profit & Loss A/c
Rs.
50,000
3,00,000
10,000
2,50,000
1,50,000
10,000
35,000
5,000
2,00,000
10,10,000
198
10. Further 50,000 equity shares were issued to the existing members for
increasing the working capital. The issue was fully subscribed and paid up.
11. Authorised capital was suitably increased.
You are required to pass the journal entries for giving effect to the above
arrangement and also to draw up the resultant balance sheet of the company.
Ans. Journal of Run Ltd.
(1) ESC a/c
Dr. 300000
To Rs.2 ESC
(2) Shares surrendered a/c
Dr. 270000
To Capital reduction a/c
(3) 8 % PSC a/c
Dr. 200000
To 9% PSC a/c
(4) Crs. a/c
Dr. 60000
To Shares surrendered a/c 35000
To capital reduction a/c
25000
(5) O/S Exp. a/c
Dr. 20000
Unsec. Loan a/c Dr. 50000
To capital reduction a/c
(6) Rs.2 ESC a/c
Dr. 235000
To Shares surrendered a/c
(7) Reconstruction exp. a/c
Dr. 10000
to Bank a/c
(8) Capital reduction a/c
Dr.
To P & L
200000
To P . Exp
5000
To Recons. Exp
10000
To goodwill
50000
To tools
8000
To stock
20000
To Plant
57000 ( balancing figure )
(9)Bank a/c Dr.
50000x10
To ESC
Q.No. 17
Q.No. 18
Q.No. 19
Q.No. 20
Q.No. 21
Q.No. 22
Q.No. 23
Q.No. 24
Q.No. 25
199
The term amalgamation for the purpose of AS-14 includes both amalgamation
and absorption. There are two conditions for an arrangement to called as
amalgamation as per this accounting standard : (i) there is blending of at least
two companies and (ii) at least one company goes into liquidation. AS-14 has
segregated amalgamation into two broad categories :
(i) Amalgamation in the nature of merger
(ii) Amalgamation in the nature of purchase.
Amalgamation is termed as amalgamation in the nature merger if all of the following
five conditions are satisfied :
The transferee28 company intends to carry on the business , of the transferor29
company, after amalgamation.
After amalgamation, all the assets and liabilities of the transferor company
become the assets and liabilities of the transferee company
Shareholders holding 90 % or more30 of the face value of equity shares of the
transferor ( immediately before the transfer ) become shareholders of the
transferee company by virtue of amalgamation. ( For the purpose of this provision,
those shares of transferor which were held be transferee or its nominees just
immediately before the amalgamation, are not considered). For example, A Ltd.
absorbs B Ltd. B Ltd.s share capital consists of 10,00.000 equity shares of Rs.
10 each. 20% of equity shares of B Ltd, are held by A Ltd. As per this condition,
the shareholders (other than A Ltd.) holding at least 72000 shares should become
the shareholders of A Ltd after the absorption.
28
Purchasing company
vendor company
30
The remaining shareholders may be dissenting shareholders.
29
200
Those shareholders of the transferor company who become shareholders of the
transferee company should get their consideration by way of equity shares of
transferee company ( except that on account of fractional shares payment may be
made in cash ).
The assets and liabilities should be carried in the books of the transferee at book
values of transferor ( except that some adjustment may be made for following the
uniform accounting policies )
An amalgamation which is not in the nature of merger, is termed as amalgamation in
the nature of purchase.
Purchase consideration : PC is what is being paid by the purchasing company to the
liquidator of the vendor company for the shareholders of the vendor company.
Accounting for merger is termed as pooling of interest method.
Under this method, the assets, liabilities and items of reserve and surplus
are recognized in the books of transferee at their book values. ( The
balance of P & L A/c of the transferor is aggregated with the
corresponding balance of the transferee company or transferred to
general reserve.)
If the transferor and transferee have been following different accounting
policies, uniform policies should be followed after amalgamation. The
effects on the financial statements of changes in accounting policies
should be reported as per AS-5.
The difference between the amount recorded as share capital issued (plus
any additional consideration )31 and the amount of share capital of the
transferor should be adjusted in the reserves.
Accounting for purchase method :
31
201
The assets and liabilities, which have been taken over, should be recorded
in the books of transferee company at their fair values ( if not known, at
their book values ).
Difference between PC and amount at which the net assets are recorded
in the books should be identified as goodwill or capital reserve if any.
Goodwill should be amortized over not more than 5 years unless a
somewhat longer period can be justified.
The statutory reserves should be taken over by debiting the Amalgamation
Adjustment A/c. This reserve should be shown in the B/S under the
heading Misc. Expenditure. When the maintenance of such reserves is
no longer statutorily required, the amount of such reserves should be
credited to Misc. expenditure a/c.
Disclosure
The following disclosures are required for all the amalgamations :
(I)
(II)
(III)
(IV)
32
202
(II)
(II)
203
TEST PAPER-I
Q.No.1)
On April 1, 1980 A Limited paid Rs. 1,10,000 for 90% of the issued capital of B Limited.
The assets and liabilities of the two companies as at March 31, 1981 were as follows
Fixed Assets
Current Assets
Investment-at cost
Goodwill
A Limited B Limited
Rs.
Rs.
94,000
96,000
30,000
18,000
1,56,000
-20,000
6,000
3,00,000
1,20,000
1,80,000
45,000
36,000
39,000
--
60,000
20,000
20,500
9,500
10,000
3,00,000
1,20,000
(1) On April 1, 1980 the opening credit balance of A Ltds Profit and Loss Account
was Rs. 26,000. Out of this balance, a 10% Dividend was paid subsequently.
(2) The Profit and Loss Account of B Limited showed the following:Rs.
22,000
12,000
34,000
Rs.
9,000
4,500
13,500
20,500
204
(3) Included in the stock-trade of B Limited at balance sheet date were goods
purchased from A Limited for Rs. 6,000 on which there was a profit of 50% on
cost of A Limited.
(4) All Dividends received by A Limited have been correctly recorded in the books
of account.
Prepared a Consolidated Balance Sheet as at March 31, 1981 and show your workings.
(CA FINAL) (25 marks) MAY 1981
Q.No.2)
The following are the Balance Sheet of H Limited and S Limited as on 31st March, 1984:Liabilities
H Ltd. Rs.
S Ltd. Rs.
Share Capital:
Equity Shares of Rs. 100 each
10,00,000
7,00,000
Reserve and Surplus:
General Reserve
2,00,000
3,00,000
Profit and Loss Account
3,00,000
3,00,000
Current Liabilities
5,00,000
9,00,000
20,00,000
22,00,000
Assets:
Fixed Assets
8,00,000
9,00,000
Investment in S Limited
5,00,000
--Current Assets
7,00,000
13,00,000
20,00,000
22,00,000
The following further information is furnished:
(1) H Limited acquired 3,000 shares in S Ltd. on 1.4.83 when the Reserve and surplus
position of S Limited was as under:
(a) General Reserve
Rs. 5,00,000
(b) Profit and Loss Account (credit balance) Rs. 2,00,000
(2) On 1.10.83 S Limited issued 2 shares for every 5 shares held, as bonus shares at a face
value of Rs. 100 per share. No entry is made, in the books of H Limited for the receipt
of these bonus shares.
(3) On 30.6.83 S Limited declared a dividend, out of pre-acquisition profits, of 20% and
H Ltd. credited the receipt of dividend to its profit and loss account.
(4) S Limited owed H Limited Rs. 1,20,000 for purchase of stock from H Limited. The
entire stock is held by S Limited on 31.3.84.
H Ltd. made a profit of 20% on cost.
(5) H Limited transferred a machine to S Ltd. for Rs. 1,00,000. The book value of
machine to H Limited was Rs. 75,000.
Prepare Consolidated Balance Sheet as at 31st March, 1984.
(CA FINAL) (20 marks) NOV. 1989
205
Q.No.3)
A Ltd. acquired 8,000 shares of Rs. 10 each in Omega Ltd on 31st December, 1994. The
summarized Balance Sheet of the two companies as on that date were as follows:
Liabilities
A Ltd.
Omega Ltd.
Share Capital
30,000 Shares of Rs. 10 each
3,00,000
--10,000 Shares of Rs. 10 each
--1,00,000
Capital Reserve
--52,000
General Reserve
25,000
5,000
Profit & Loss Account
38,200
18,000
Loan from Omega Ltd.
2,100
--Bills Payable (including Rs. 500 to A Ltd.)
--1,700
Creditors
17,900
5,000
Note on the Balance Sheet of A Ltd. : There
is a contingent liability for bills discounted of
Rs. 1000.
3,83,200
1,81,700
Assets
Fixed Assets
1,50,000
1,44,700
Investment in Omega Ltd. at cost
1,70,000
--Stock in hand
40,000
20,000
Loan to A Ltd.
--2,000
Bills Receivable (including Rs. 200 from
1,200
--Omega Ltd.)
Debtors
20,000
10,000
Banks
2,000
5,000
3,83,200
1,81,700
You are given the following information:
(a) Omega Ltd. made a bonus issue on 31st December, 1994 of one share for every two
shares held, reducing the capital reserve equivalently, but the transaction is not shown
in the above Balance Sheets.
(b) Interest receivable (Rs. 100) in respect of the loan due by A Ltd. to Omega Ltd. has
not been credited in the accounts of Omega Ltd.
206
(c) The directors decided that the fixed assets of Omega Ltd. were over-valued and should
be written down by Rs. 5,000.
Prepare the Consolidated Balance Sheet as at 31st December 1994, showing your workings.
(CA FINAL)
(15 marks) (MAY, 1995)
Q.No.4)
A Ltd. acquired 8,000 shares of Rs. 100 each in B Ltd. on 30th September 1991. The
summarized balance Sheets of the two companies as on 31st March 1992 were as follows:
A Ltd. Rs.
B Ltd. Rs.
Share Capital: 30,000 Shares of Rs. 100 each
30,00,000
10,000 Shares of Rs. 100 each
10,00,000
Capital Reserve
--5,50,000
General Reserve
3,00,000
50,000
Profit and Loss Account
3,82,000
1,80,000
Loan from B Ltd.
21,000
--Bills Payable (including Rs. 5,000 to A Ltd.)
--17,000
Creditors
1,79,000
70,000
Note: On the Balance Sheet of A Ltd.: There is a
contingent liability for bills discounted of Rs. 6000
38,82,000
18,67,000
Fixed Assets
15,00,000
14,47,000
Investment in B Ltd. as cost
17,00,000
--Stock in hand
4,00,000
2,00,000
Loan to A Ltd.
--20,000
Bills Receivable (including Rs. 5,000 from B Ltd.)
12,000
--Debtors
2,50,000
1,80,000
Cash and Bank balance
20,000
20,000
38,82,200
18,67,000
You are given the following information:
(1) B Ltd. made a bonus issue on 31st March 1992 of one share for every two
shares held, reducing the Capital Reserve equivalently but the accounting
effect to this has not been given in the above Balance Sheet.
(2) Interest receivable for the year (Rs. 1,000) in respect of the loan due by A Ltd.
to B Ltd. has not been credited in the books of B Ltd.
(3) The credit balance in Profit and Loss Account of B Ltd. as on 1.4.1991 was Rs.
21,000.
(4) The directors decided on the date of acquisition the fixed assets of B Ltd. were
over-valued and should be written down by Rs. 50,000. Consequential
adjustments on depreciation is to be ignored.
207
Prepared the Consolidated Balance Sheet as at 31st March 1992 showing your working.
(CA FINAL) (15 marks) (May, 1992)
Q.No.5)
The Balance Sheets of Sun Ltd. and Moon Ltd. as on 31.3.2000 are given below:
Liabilities
Sun Ltd
Moon
Assets
Sun Ltd. Moon
Rs.
Ltd.
Rs.
Ltd. Rs.
Rs.
Share Capital (Rs. 10)
1,20,000 1,00,000 Fixed Assets
44,000
84,000
General Reserve
20,0000
36,000 Investment in
Moon Ltd 8000
shares
88,000
----Profit and Loss A/c
12,000
20,000 Sundry Debtors
6,000
15,000
Bills Payable
2,000
5,000 Bills Receivable
4,000
16,000
Sundry Creditors
4,000
7,000 Stock in Trade
10,000
40,000
Cash in Bank
6,000
13,000
1,58,000 1,68,000
1,58,000 1,68,000
Contingent liabilities of SUN LTD.: Bills discounted , not yet matured Rs. 2,500.
Shares were purchased on 1.4.1997. When the shares were purchased, General Reserve &
Profit and Loss Account of Moon Ltd. stood at Rs. 30,000 and Rs. 16,000 respectively.
Dividends have been paid @ 10% every year after acquisition of shares, first dividend
being paid out of pre-acquisition profits. No dividend has been proposed for 1999-2000
as yet and no provision need be made in consolidated Balance Sheet. Sun Ltd. has
credited all dividend received to Profit and Loss Account.
On 31.3.2000, Bonus shares has been decided by Moon Ltd. @ 1 fully paid share
for 5 held, but no effect has been given to that in the above accounts. The Bonus was
declared out of profits earned prior to 1.4.1997 from General Reserve.
When the shares were purchased, agreed evaluations of Fixed Assets of Moon Ltd.
was Rs. 1,08,000 although no effect has been given thereto in accounts.
Depreciation has been charged @ 10% p.a. on the book value as on 1.4.1997, (on
straight line method), there being no addition or sale since then.
Out of Current Profits Rs. 2,000 has been transferred to general reserve ever year.
Bills receivable of Sun Ltd. include Rs. 2,000 bills accepted by Moon Ltd. and bills
208
discounted by Sun Ltd., but not yet matured include Rs. 1,500 accepted by Moon Ltd.
Sundry creditors of Sun Ltd. include Rs. 2,000 due to Moon Ltd. whereas Sundry Debtors
of Moon Ltd. include Rs. 4,000 due from Sun Ltd. It is found that Sun Ltd has remitted a
cheque of Rs. 2,000 which has not yet been received by Moon Ltd.
Prepare Consolidated Balance Sheet as at 31.3.2000 of Sun Ltd. and its subsidiary.
(MAY 2000) 20 marks (CA FINAL)
209
Q.No.6)
TEST PAPER-II
Study Mat Illustration. 8. A Ltd. acquired 70%
(Holding Company Chapter)
Q.No.7)
Q.No.8)
X Ltd. purchased its raw materials from Y Ltd. and sells goods to Z Ltd.
In order to ensure regular supply of raw materials and patronage for finished
goods, X Ltd. through its wholly owned subsidiary, X Investment Ltd. acquired on
31st December, 1996, 51% of equity capital of Y Ltd. for Rs. 15 crores and 76%
of equity capital of Z Ltd. for 30 crores. X Investment Ltd. was floated by X Ltd. in
1990 from which date it was wholly owned by X Ltd.
The following are the Balance Sheet of the four companies as on 31st
December, 1996.
(Rs. In crores)
Share Capital:
Equity (fully Paid)
Rs. 10 each
Reserves and Surplus
Loan Funds:
Secured
Unsecured
Total Sources
Fixed Assets:
Cost
Less: Depreciation
X Ltd. Rs.
Z Ltd. Rs.
25
15
75
15
10
100
25
125
60
35
20
--50
10
25
50
75
--25
---
15
5
10
25
15
40
15
---
20
20
15
35
35
70
30
8
17
Investment at cost in
Fully paid Equity Shares
of:
X Investment Ltd.
5
----Y Ltd.
--15
--Z Ltd.
--30
--Other
Companies
(Market Value Rs. 116
Cr.)
--29
--Net Current Assets:
Current Assets
105
1
96
200
Current Liabilities
10
95 --1 64
32 143
Total
125
75
40
There are no inter-company transaction outstanding between the companies.
13
-------
---
57
70
210
You are asked to prepare consolidated balance sheet as at 31st December, 1996.
(Part of Q. No. 1) (CA FINAL) (MAY, 97)
Q.No.9)
Following are the Balance Sheets of H Ltd. and S Ltd. as at 31st March, 1990.
Liabilities
H Ltd
S Ltd.
Assets
H Ltd.
S
Ltd.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Equity Share Capital of 6,00,000 1,00,000 Land & Building
2,00,000 1,00,000
Rs. 10 each fully paid
General Reserve
50,000
30,000 Machineries
2,80,000
50,000
Profit and Loss A/c
80,000
40,000 7,000 Shares of S 1,00,000
--Ltd.
Sundry Creditors
1,00,000
40,000 Stock
70,000
40,000
Bills Payable
10,000
15,000 Debtors
1,50,000
20,000
Bills Receivable
10,000
--Cash at Bank
30,000
15,000
Total
8,40,000 2,25,000
8,40,000 2,25,000
Additional information:
(i)
All the Bills Receivable of H Ltd. including those discounted were accepted
by S Ltd.
(ii)
When 6,000 shares were acquired by H Ltd. in S Ltd., S Ltd. had Rs. 20,000
General Reserve and Rs. 5,000 Credit balance in Profit and Loss Accounts.
(iii)
At the time of acquisition of further 1,000 shares by H Ltd., S Ltd. had Rs.
25,000 General Reserve and Rs. 28,000 Credit Balance in Profit and Loss
Account from which 20% dividend was paid by S Ltd. and dividend received
by H Ltd. on these shares were credited to Profit and Loss Account.
(iv)
Stock of S Ltd. include Rs. 20,000 purchased from H Ltd., which has made
25% profit on cost.
(v)
Both the Companies has proposed dividend H Ltd. 10% S Ltd. 15% but no
effect has yet been given in the above Balance Sheets.
Prepare Consolidated Balance Sheet as at 31st March, 1990.
(CA FINAL) (20 Marks) NOV 1990
Q.No.10) Illustration.. 18 Study Mat. (Holding Co. Chapter)
211
212
TEST PAPER-III
Q.No.11)
The following are the Balance Sheet of H Limited and S Limited as on
30th September, 1985:Liabilities
Share Capital:
Equity Share of Rs. 100 each
12% Preference Shares of Rs. 100 each
Reserve and Surplus:
General Reserve
Profit and Loss Account
Current Liabilities and Provisions:
Creditors
Income Tax
Total
Assets:
Fixed Assets:
Goodwill
Machinery
Vehicles
Furniture
Shares in S Ltd. at Cost
Current Assets:
Stock
Debtors
Bank Balance
Total
H Ltd. Rs.
S Ltd. Rs.
5,00,000
1,00,000
2,00,000
50,000
1,00,000
1,50,000
60,000
90,000
60,000
70,000
9,80,000
70,000
60,000
5,30,000
60,000
1,00,000
1,80,000
50,000
3,80,000
40,000
60,000
70,000
30,000
----------
70,000
1,00,000
40,000
9,80,000
1,40,000
1,65,000
25,000
5,30,000
213
Q.No.12)
The following are the balance sheets of H Ltd., A Ltd. and B Ltd. as on 31.12.1983:Liabilities
Shares Capital
Reserves
P & L Account
Creditors
Bills Payable
Assets
Sundry Assets
Stock
Debtors
B/R from A Ltd.
Shares in A Ltd.
Shares in B Ltd.
H Ltd. Rs.
A Ltd. Rs.
B Ltd. Rs.
10,00,000
2,00,000
1,00,000
1,00,000
60,000
60,000
4,00,000
1,20,000
60,000
2,00,000
1,20,000
60,000
--30,000
--17,00,000
5,30,000
2,80,000
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
8,00,000
1,20,000
1,00,000
6,10,000
1,80,000
1,00,000
1,30,000
1,70,000
80,000
10,000
1,50,000
60,000
17,00,000
5,30,000
2,80,000
H Ltd. purchased 80% of shares in A Ltd. when latters profit and loss account was Rs.
80,000 and Reserve was Rs. 40,000.
A Ltd. purchased 75% of shares in B Ltd. when latters profit and loss account was Rs.
40,000 and reserve was Rs. 20,000. Prepare consolidated Balance Sheet of H Ltd. and its
subsidiaries A Ltd. and B Ltd. as on 31st December, 1983 together with consolidation
schedules.
CA FINAL (25 Marks) MAY 1989
Q.NO.13)
The following is a summary of the Balance Sheet of A Ltd. and its two subsidiaries, Ram
Ltd. and Rahim Ltd. as on 31st March, 1991.
A Ltd. Rs.
Issued Share Capital:
Fully paid up Shares of Rs. 10 each
Profit and Loss Account
Sundry Assets less Liabilities
10,000 Shares in Ram Ltd. at cost
90,000 shares of Rahim at cost
2,00,000
5,23,500
7,23,500
5,63,500
1,60,000
Rahim Ltd
Rs.
1,60,000
2,00,100
3,60,100
2,10,100
1,00,000
2,59,400
3,59,400
3,59,400
1,50,000
7,23,500 3,60,100
3,59,400
When A Ltd. purchased shares in Ram Ltd. on 30th September, 1988, there was a credit
balance of Rs. 1,46,500 in the Profit and Loss Account of Ram Ltd. and when Ram Ltd.
purchased shares of Rahim Ltd. on 31st March, 1989 there was a credit balance of Rs.
40,000 in the Profit and Loss Account of Rahim Ltd.
214
Prepare a Consolidated Balance Sheet of the group as on 31st March, 1991, showing your
workings. Calculations to be made to the nearest rupee. (Nov. 1991) CA FINAL
Q.No.14)
From the following Balance Sheet of group of companies and the other information
provided, draw up the consolidated Balance Sheet as on 31.03.98. Figures given are in
Rupees Lakhs:
Balance Sheets as on 31.3.98
X
Y
Z
X
Y
Z
Share capital (in shares of 300 200 100 Fixed assets less
130 150 100
Rs. 100 each)
depreciation
Reserves
50
40
30
Cost of Investment 180 in Y Ltd.
Profit & Loss Balance
60
50
40
Cost of Investment 40 in Z Ltd.
Cost of Investment 80 in Z Ltd.
Bills payable
10
5
Stock
50 20 20
Creditors
30
10
10
Debtors
70 10 20
Y Ltd. balance
15
Bills receivables
10 20
Z Ltd balance
50
Z Ltd. balance
10 X Ltd. balance
30
Cash and bank
30 20 10
balance
Total
500 300 200 Total
500 300 200
X Ltd. holds 1,60,000 shares and 30,000 shares respectively in Y Ltd. and Z Ltd. ,
Y Ltd. holds 60,000 shares in Z Ltd. These investments were made on 1.7.97 on
which date the position was as follows:
Y Ltd.
Z Ltd.
Reserves
20
10
Profit & Loss Account
30
16
In December 1997 Y Ltd. invoiced goods to X Ltd. for Rs. 40 Lakhs at cost plus
25%. The closing stock of X Ltd. includes such goods valued at Rs. 5 lakhs.
Z Ltd. sold to Y Ltd. an equipment costing Rs. 24 lakhs at a profit of 25% on
selling price on 1.1.98. Depreciation at 10% per annum was provided by Y Ltd.
on this equipment.
Bills payables of Z Ltd. represent acceptance given to Y Ltd. out of which Y Ltd.
had discounted bills worth Rs. 3 lakhs.
Debtors of X Ltd. include Rs. 5 lakhs being the amount due from Y Ltd.
X Ltd. proposes dividend at 10%.
CA FINAL (MAY, 98) (20 marks)
Q.No.15)
215
TEST PAPER IV
Q. No. 16 : On 31st March, 2004, War Ltd purchased 48,000 shares in Peace Ltd at 50%
premium over face value by issue of 8% debentures at 20% premium. The balance sheets
of War Ltd and Peace Ltd as on 31.3.2004 were as under :
Liabilities
War Ltd. Peace Ltd. Assets
War Ltd.
Peace
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
Ltd.(Rs.)
Share capital
10,50,000 6,00,000
FA
6,50,000
2,00,000
(Rs.10)
General reserve
1,20,000
40,000
Stock
3,00,000
1,80,000
P & L a/c
80,000 ------Drs.
3,20,000
2,00,000
Creditors
1,00,000
60,000
Cash
60,000
30,000
Preliminary exp.
20,000
10,000
P & L A/C
-----80,000
TOTAL
13,50,000 7,00,000
TOTAL
13,50,000 7,00,000
Particulars of War Ltd. :
(i) Profit made : 2004-05 ..Rs.1,60,000;
2005-06.Rs. 2,00,000
(ii) the above profit was made after charging depreciation of Rs. 60000 and Rs. 40000
respectively.
(iii) Out of profit shown above, every year Rs.20000 had been transferred to general
reserve.
(iv) 10% dividend had been paid in both the years.
(v) it has been decided to write down investment to face value of shares in 10 years and
to provide for share of loss to subsidiary.
Particulars of Peace Ltd. : The company incurred losses of Rs.40,000 and Rs. 60,000 in
2004-05 and 2005-06 after charging depreciation of 10 % on book value as on 1.4.2004.
Prepare consolidated B/S , as at 31.3.2006, of War Ltd and its subsidiary. (Nov.99 CA
Final, Dates changed)
Q. No. 17 : Illustration 11 of the Study Material ( Holding co. chapter)
Q. No. 18 : Illustration 15 of the Study Material ( Holding co. chapter ). Prepare
Consolidated B/S by Pooling of interest method.
Pooling of interest method of consolidation : three important points:
(i)
No distinction is made between revenue profit and capital profit.
(ii)
In Consolidated B/S, we take holding co.s profit + holding companys share
in profit ( both pre and post acquisition ) of subsidiary company.
(iii)
Reserve and surplus in the consolidated B/S is adjusted by difference between
PC and paid up value of shares acquired.
Q. No. 19 : Illustration 16 of the Study Material ( Holding co. chapter)
Q. No. 20 : Illustration 25 of the Study Material ( Holding co. chapter)
216
TEST PAPER-V
Illustration. 1 study Mat. Page 4.4.
Q.No.21)
Q.No.22)
Following are the Balance Sheet of Mumbai Limited Delhi, Limited, Amritsar Limited
and Kanpur Limited as at 31st December, 2000.
Liabilities
Mumbai
Delhi
Amritsar
Kanpur
Ltd.
Ltd.
Ltd.
Ltd.
Share Capital (Rs. 100 face
50,00,000 40,00,000
20,00,000
60,00,000
value)
General Reserve
20,00,000
4,00,000
2,50,000
10,00,000
Profit & Loss Account
10,00,000
4,00,000
2,50,000
3,20,000
3,00,000
1,00,000
50,000
80,000
Total
83,00,000 49,00,000
25,50,000
74,00,000
Assets
Investment:
30,000 shares in Delhi Ltd.
35,000,00
------10,000 shares in Amritsar Ltd.
11,00,000
------5,000 shares in Amritsar Ltd.
5,00,000
----Shares in Kanpur Ltd @Rs.120
36,00,000 18,00,000
6,00,000
--Fixed Assets
20,00,000
15,00,000
70,00,000
Current Assets
1,00,000
6,00,000
4,50,000
4,00,000
Total
83,00,000 49,00,000
25,50,000
74,00,000
Balance in General Reserve a/c and P & L a/c, when shares were purchased in different
companies were :
Mumbai Ltd. Delhi Ltd.
Amritsar Ltd. Kanpur Ltd.
General Reserve A/c
10,00,000
2,00,000
1,00,000
6,00,000
Profit & Loss A/c
6,00,000
2,00,000
50,000
60,000
st
Required: Prepare the consolidated Balance Sheet of the group as at 31 December, 2000
(Calculations may be rounded off to nearest rupee). CA FINAL (MAY 2001) (16 Marks)
Q.No.23
Following are the draft Balance Sheets of two companies A Ltd. and B Ltd. as at
31.03.1996:
(Rs. In Lakhs)
Liabilities
A Ltd.
B Ltd.
Assets
A Ltd.
B Ltd.
Share Capital
6.00
3.00
Fixed Assets
5.00
1.50
Rs.100 each
Capital Profit
0.80
0.85
Investment:
Revenue Profit
3.20
0.29
2,400 Shares in 3.00
B Ltd.
Crs.
1.50
0.81
1,200 Shares in --2.00
A Ltd.
Debtors
2.00
0.80
Stock
0.40
0.30
Cash & Bank
1.10
0.35
11.50
4.95
11.50
4.95
217
Total
A Ltd.
Rs.
1,00,000
48,000
16,000
3,000
7,000
1,74,000
B Ltd.
Rs.
1,00,000
10,000
12,000
5,000
7,000
1,34,000
C Ltd.
Rs.
60,000 Fixed Assets
9,000 Investment
9,000 Shares in B Ltd.
A Ltd.
Rs.
20,000
B Ltd.
Rs.
60,000
Shares in C Ltd.
Stock in Trade
B. Ltd. Balance
Sundry Debtors
A Ltd. Balance
78,000 Total
13,000
12,000
8,000
26,000
53,000
1,74,000
1,34,000
C Ltd.
Rs.
43,000
95,000
21,000
32,000
3,000
78,000
You are required to prepare the Consolidated Balance Sheet of the group as on 31.12.2000.
CA FINAL (MAY, 2002) (16 Marks)
218
Q.No.25
The Balance Sheet of Bat Ltd. and Ball Ltd. as on 31.3.2000 are as follows:
Share Capital
(Shares of Rs.
10 each)
Profit and
Loss account
Creditors
Bat Ltd.
Rs.
Ball Ltd.
Rs.
1,60,000
2,00,000 Debtors
Stock
60,000 Cash at Bank
16,000 Cash in hand
2,76,000
50,000
--2,10,000
Assets
Bat Ltd.
Rs.
Investment: Shares 1,96,000
in Ball Ltd.
--------14,000
2,10,000
8,000
6,000
Ball Ltd.
Rs.
1,20,000
80,000
70,000
6,000
2,76,000
Cost
1,10,000
86,000
(3) The shares purchased on 31.7.99 are ex-dividend and ex-bonus from existing holders.
(4) On 31.7.99 dividend at 10% was received from Ball Ltd. and was credited to Profit
and Loss Account.
(5) On 31.7.99 it received bonus shares from Ball Ltd. in the ratio of one share on every
four shares held.
(6) Bat Ltd. incurred on expenditure of Rs. 500 per month on behalf of Ball Ltd. and this
was debited to the Profit and Loss account of Bat Ltd., but nothing has been done in
the books of Ball Ltd.
(7) The balance in the Profit and Loss account as on 31.3.2000 included Rs. 36,000 being
the net profit made during the year.
(8) Dividend proposed for 1999-2000 at 10% was not provided for as yet.
Particulars of Ball Ltd.:
(1) The balance in the Profit and Loss account as on 31.3.2000 is after the issue of bonus
shares made on 31.7.99.
(2) The net profit made during the year is Rs. 24,000 including Rs. 6,000 received from
insurance company in settlement of the claim towards loss of stock by fire on 30.6.99
(Cost Rs. 10,800 included in opening stock).
(3) Dividend proposed for 1999-2000 at 10% was not provided for in the accounts.
Prepare the Consolidated Balance Sheet of Bat Ltd. as on 31.3.2000.
(16
marks)(Nov. 2000 CA FINAL)
219
TEST PAPER-VI
Q.No.26)
The Summarized Balance Sheet of A Limited and B Limited are as follows:
Balance Sheets as at 31st December, 2000
A Ltd.
B Ltd.
Rs.
Rs.
Sources of Funds:
Share Capital in equity shares of Rs. 10 each
2,00,000
50,000
Reserves
20,000
5,000
st
Profit and Loss Account as on 1 January,2000
30,000
10,000
Profit for the year
8,000
8,000
Add: Dividends from B Ltd.
4,0000
--Less: Dividends paid
--(5,000)
Creditors
30,000
20,000
Total
2,92,000
88,000
Application of Funds:
Fixed Assets
2,00,000
80,000
Current Assets
32,000
8,000
Shares in B Ltd. At cost 3,000 shares
60,000
--Total
2,92,000
88,000
A Limited had acquired 4,000 shares in B Limited at Rs. 20 each on 1st January,
2000 and sold 1,000 of them at the same price on 1st October, 2000. The sale is cum
dividend. An interim dividend of 10% was paid by B Limited on 1st July, 2000.
Draft the consolidated Balance Sheet as at 31st December, 2000.
(Nov. 2001 CA FINAL)
220
Q.No.27)
On 31st March, 2002, the Balance Sheets of H Ltd. And S Ltd. Stood as follows:
H Ltd.
Rs.
Liabilities:
Equity Share Capital Authorised
Issued and subscribed in Equity Shares of Rs. 10 each
fully paid
General Reserve
Profit and Loss Account
Bills Payable
Sundry Creditors
Provision for Taxation
Other Provisions
Assets.
Plant and Machinery
Furniture and Fittings
Investment in the Equity Shares of S Ltd.
Stock
Debtors
Bills Receivables
Cash and Bank Balances
Sundry Advances
S Ltd.
Rs.
5,000
4,000
3,000
2,400
928
1,305
124
487
220
65
7,129
690
810
80
427
180
17
4,604
2,541
615
1,500
983
700
120
410
260
7,129
2,450
298
--786
683
95
102
190
4,604
221
Q.No.28)
On 31st March, 1996, P Ltd. acquired 1,05,000 shares of Q Ltd. for Rs. 12,00,000. The
Balance Sheet of Q Ltd. on that date was as under:
Liabilities:
Rs. Assets
Rs.
1,50,000 equity shares of
Fixed Assets
10,50,000
Rs.10 each fully paid
15,00,000 Current Assets
6,45,000
Pre-incorporation profits
30,000
Profit and Loss Account
60,000
Creditors
1,05,000
16,95,000
16,95,000
st
On 31 March, 2002 the Balance Sheets of two companies were as follows:
P Ltd. Rs.
Q Ltd.
P Ltd.
Q Ltd.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Equity shares of
Fixed Assets
79,20,000
23,10,000
Rs. 10 each fully
1,05,000 equity
Shares in Q Ltd.
paid. (before
bonus issue)
45,00,000
15,00,000 At cost
12,00,000
--Securities
9,00,000
--Current Assets
44,10,000
17,55,000
premium
Pre-incorporation
profits
--30,000
General Reserve
60,00,000
19,05,000
profits and Loss
Account
15,75,000
4,20,000
Creditors
5,55,000
2,10,000
1,35,30,000 40,65,000
1,35,30,000 40,65,000
Directors of Q Ltd. made bonus issue on 31.3.2002 in the ratio of one equity share
of Rs. 10 each fully paid for every two equity shares held on that date.
Calculate as on 31st March, 2002 (i) Cost of Control/Capital Reserve; (ii)
Minority Interest; (iii) Consolidated Profit and Loss Account in each of the following
cases: (i)Before issue of bonus shares. (ii) Immediately after issue of bonus shares. It may
be assumed that bonus shares were issued out of post-acquisition profits by using General
Reserve. Prepare a Consolidated Balance Sheet after the bonus issue. (May, 2003 CA )
222
Q.No.29)
The following are the summarised Balance Sheets of PD Co. Ltd. and SD Co. Ltd. as on
31.3.2004:
Liabilities
PD Co. Ltd.Rs.
SD Co. Ltd. Rs.
Share Capital:
70,00,000
30,00,000
Authorised
Issued and Subscribed Capital
Equity shares of Rs. 10 each
Fully paid
50,00,000
20,00,000
Capital Reserve
5,00,000
3,10,000
Revenue Reserve
8,50,000
75,000
Profit and Loss Account
4,00,000
2,80,000
Sundry Creditors
2,50,000
2,25,000
Bills Payable
1,00,000
10,000
71,00,000
29,00,000
Assets:
Land and Buildings
20,00,000
15,20,000
Plant and Machinery
20,00,000
8,00,000
Furniture
5,00,000
1,60,000
Investments
16,10,000
--Stock
3,40,000
1,00,000
Sundry Debtors
3,60,000
2,00,000
Bills Receivable
50,000
40,000
Bank
2,40,000
80,000
71,00,000
29,00,000
PD Ltd. acquired 80% shares of SD Ltd. on 30.9.2003 at a cost of Rs. 18,10,000.
On 1.10.03 SD Ltd. declared and paid dividend on Equity shares. PD Ltd. appropriately
adjust its shares of dividend in Investment Account.
On 1.4.03, the Capital reserve and Profit and Loss Account stood in the books of
SD Ltd. at Rs. 50,000 and Rs. 2,75,000 respectively.
Land and Buildings standing in the books of SD Ltd. at Rs. 16,00,000 on 1.4.03,
revalued at Rs. 20,00,000 on 1.10.03. Furniture, which stood in the books at Rs. 2,00,000
on 1.4.03 revalued at Rs. 1,50,000 on 1.10.03. In both the cases the effects have not yet
been given in the books.
SD Ltd. bought an item of machinery from PD Ltd. on hire-purchase basis. The
following are the balances in respect of this machinery in the books on 31.03.04:
Rs.
Installment due
20,000
Installment not due
8,000
Hire-purchase stock reserve
1,600
The above item stood included under appropriate heads in Balance Sheet.
Prepare a Consolidated Balance Sheet of PD Ltd. and its subsidiary SD Ltd. as at
31.03.2004, Complying with the requirements of AS-21(Nov. 2004 CA FINAL)
223
Q.No.30)
The Balance Sheets of Football Ltd. and its subsidiary Hockey Ltd. as on 31st March,
2005 are as under:
Liabilities
Equity shares of
Rs. 10 each
10% preference
shares of Rs. 10 each
General reserve
P/L A/c
Bank overdraft
Sundry creditors
Bills payable
Football
Ltd. Rs.
48,00,000
Hockey
Ltd. Rs.
Assets
Goodwill
20,00,000 Plant & Mach.
7,00,000
5,50,000
10,00,000
1,20,000
4,30,000
---
3,80,000
4,20,000
6,00,000
70,000
4,80,000
1,60,000
76,00,000
41,10,000
Motor vehicles
Furniture &
fittings
Investments
Stock
Cash at bank
Debtors
Bills receivable
Football
Ltd. Rs.
Hockey
Ltd. Rs.
4,50,000
12,00,000
3,00,000
5,00,000
9,50,000
7,50,000
6,50,000
26,00,000
4,50,000
2,25,000
9,30,000
1,45,000
76,00,000
4,00,000
4,50,000
7,20,000
2,10,000
7,80,000
--41,10,000
Nos. acquired
Date of acquisition
Cost of acquisition
Rs.
Preference shares
Equity shares
Equity shares
14,250
80,000
70,000
1.4.2002
1.4.2003
1.4.2004
3,10,000
9,50,000
8,00,000
Other information :
(i)
On 1.4.2004 Profit and Loss Account and general of Hockey Ltd. had credit
balances Rs. 3,00,000 and Rs. 2,00,000 respectively.
(ii)
Dividend @10% was paid by Hockey Ltd. for the year 2003-04 out of its P/L
balance as on 1.4.2004. Football Ltd. credited its share of dividend to its P/L A/c.
(iii)
Hockey Ltd. allotted bonus shares out of general reserve at the rate of 1 share for
every 10 shares held. Accounting thereof has not yet been made.
(iv)
Bills receivable of Football Ltd. were drawn upon Hockey Ltd.
(v)
During the year 2004-05 Football Ltd. purchased goods from Hockey Ltd. of Rs.
1,00,000 at a sale price of Rs. 1,20,000. 40% of these goods remained unsold at
close of the year.
(vi)
On 1.4.2004 motor vehicles of Hockey Ltd. were overvalued by Rs. 1,00,000.
Applicable depreciation rate is 20%.
(vii) Dividends recommended for the year 2004-05 in the holding and the subsidiary
companies are 15% and 10% respectively.
Prepare consolidated Balance Sheet as on 31st March, 2005.
(May 2005 CA FINAL)
224
TEST PAPER-VII
STUDY MATERIAL ILLUSTRATION 3 KUBER LTD. PAGE 2.123
Q.No.31)
Q.No.32)
The following is the Balance Sheet of Alpha Limited as at 31st December, 1988:Liabilities
Share Capital:
Equity shares of
Rs. 100 each 10,00,000
Less calls in
arrear (Rs.20
for final call) 1,00,000
Reserve and Surplus:
General Reserve
Profit and Loss Account
Current Liabilities:
Sundry Creditors
Rs.
9,00,000
3,50,000
2,50,000
5,00,000
20,00,000
Assets
Fixed Assets:
Land and building
Machinery
Motorcar
Furniture
Investment (face value)
Current Assets:
Stock
Sundry debtors
Cash in Bank
Miscellaneous
Expenditure:
Preliminary Exp.
Rs.
4,00,000
4,50,000
25,000
25,000
50,000
7,25,000
2,00,000
1,05,000
20,000
20,00,000
225
Q.No.33)
Balance Sheet of Major Ltd. as on 31st December, 1982:Liabilities
Rs.
Assets
Share Capital:
Fixed Assets:
Equity Shares of
Goodwill
Rs. 10 each
5,00,000
Machinery
Less:
Factory Shed
Call in arrear
Vehicles
(Rs. 2 on final call) 10,000
4,90,000 Furniture
8% preference Share of Rs. 10 each
Investments
Fully paid
2,00,000 Current Assets:
Reserve and Surplus:
Stock in Trade:
General Reserve
2,00,000 Sundry Debtors
Profit and Loss Account
1,40,000 Cash at Bank
Current Liabilities:
Preliminary Exp.
Bank Loan
1,00,000
Sundry Creditors
2,70,000
14,00,000
Rs.
50,000
2,30,000
3,00,000
60,000
25,000
1,00,000
2,10,000
3,50,000
50,000
25,000
14,00,000
Additional Information:
(1) Fixed Assets are worth 20% above their actual book value, Depreciation on
appreciated value of fixed assets to be ignored for valuation of goodwill.
(2) Of the investments, 80% is non trade and the balance is trade. All trade investments
are to be valued at 20% below cost. A uniform rate of dividend of 10% is earned on
all investment.
(3) For the purpose of valuation of shares, Goodwill is to be considered on the basis of 4
yeas purchase of the super-profits based on average profit of the last 3 years.
Profit are as follow:
Rs.
1980
1,90,000
1981
2,00,000
1982
2,10,000
In similar business return on capital employed is 15%. In 1980 new furniture costing Rs.
10,000 was purchased but wrongly charged to revenue. (No effect has yet been given for
rectifying the same). Depreciation is charged on furniture @ 10%. Find out the value of
each fully paid and party-paid equity share.
(CA FINAL) (20 Marks) NOV. 1983
226
Q.No.34)
Below is given the Balance Sheet of Devta of Ltd. as at 31st December, 1981.
Liabilities
Rs.
Assets
Rs.
Share Capital:
Fixed Assets:
Equity Shares of
Goodwill
20,000
Rs. 10 each
2,00,000
Machinery
1,10,000
Less calls in arrear
Land & Building
1,20,000
(Rs.2 for final call)
5,000
1,95,000 Furniture & Fixtures
60,000
6% preference Shares
1,00,000
Vehicles
80,000
(Rs. 10 each)
Investments
80,000
Less calls in arrear
Current Assets:
(Rs.2 for final call)
1,000
99,000 Stock and Trade
55,000
Reserve and Surplus:
Sundry Debtors
90,000
General Reserve
80,000 Cash and Bank
10,000
Profit and Loss Account
16,000 Preliminary Exp.
10,000
Current Liabilities
Bank Loan
60,000
Bills Payable
30,000
Sundry Creditors
1,55,000
6,35,000
6,35,000
Additional Information:(1) For the Purpose of valuation of shares, Goodwill is to be considered on the basis of 2
years purchase of the super profits based on average profit of last 4 years.
Profits are as follows:1978 Rs. 80,000
1980 Rs. 1,05,000
1979 Rs. 90,000
1981 Rs. 1,10,000
(2) In a similar business normal return on capital employed in 15%.
(3) Fixed assets are worth 30% above their actual book value. Stock is over-valued by Rs.
5,000. Debtors are to be reduced by Rs. 1,000. All investment are to be valued at 10%
below cost.
(4) Of the investment, 10% is trade and the balance non-trade. Trade investments were
purchased on 1.1.1981. 50% of the non-trade investments were acquired on 1.1.80
and the rest on 1.1.79. A uniform rate of dividend of 10% is earned on all investments.
The following further information is relevant:
(1) In 1979 a new machinery costing Rs. 10,000 was purchased but wrongly charged
to revenue. (No Rectification has yet been made for above).
(2) In 1980 some old furniture (Book value Rs. 5,000) was disposed of for Rs. 3,000/You are required to value each fully paid and partly paid equity share.
(Depreciation is charged on machinery @ 10% on reducing system. Ignore
Taxation and Dividend).
(CA FINAL)(20 marks) MAY 1982
227
Q.No.35)
The Balance Sheets of X Ltd. are as follows:
Liabilities
Share Capital
General Reserve
Profit and Loss Account
Term Loans
Sundry Creditors
Provision for Tax
Proposed Dividend
Assets
Fixed Assets and Investments (Non-trade)
Stock
Debtors
Cash and Bank
(Rs. In lakhs)
As at 31.3.96
As at 31.3.97
1,000.0
1,000.0
800.0
850.0
120.0
175.0
370.0
330.0
70.0
90.0
22.5
25.0
200.0
250.0
2,582.5
2,720.0
1,600.0
550.0
340.0
92.5
2,582.5
1,800.0
600.0
220.0
100.0
2,720.0
Other Information:
1. Current cost of fixed assets excluding non-trade investment on 31.3.96 Rs. 2,200
lakhs and on 31.3.97 Rs. 2,532.8 lakhs.
2. Current cost of stock on 31.3.96 Rs. 670 lakhs and on 31.3.97 Rs. 750 lakhs.
3. Non-trade investments in 10% government securities Rs. 490 lakhs.
4. Debtors include foreign exchange debtors amounting to $ 70,000 recorded at the rate
of $ 1 = Rs. 17.50, but the closing exchange rate was $ 1 = Rs. 21.50.
5. Creditors include foreign exchange creditors amounting to $ 1,20,000 recorded at the
rate of $ 1 = Rs. 16.50, but the closing exchange rate was $ 1 = Rs. 21.50.
6. Profit included Rs. 120 lakhs being government subsidy which is not likely to recur.
7. Rs. 247 lakhs being the last installment of R and D cost were written off the profit
and loss account. This expenditure is not likely to recur.
8. Tax rate during 96-97 was 50%, effective future tax rate is estimated at 40%.
9. Normal rate of return is expected at 15%.
Based on the information furnished, Mr. Iral, a director, contends that the company does
not have any goodwill. Examine his contention.
(CA FINAL (NOV. 97) (20 marks)
228
TEST PAPER- VIII
Q.No.36)
The Balance Sheet of Hari Private Ltd. disclose the following position on 31st December
1994.
Rs.
Share Capital
Subscribed:
20,000 5% preference share of
Rs. 10 each fully paid
30,000 ordinary shares of
Rs. 10 each fully paid
General Reserve
Profit & Loss A/c.
Trade Creditors
Rs.
3,00,000
4,00,000
2,00,000
2,00,000
1,00,000
12,00,000
It is proposed to convert Hari Private Ltd. into a public limited company and for this
purpose you are asked to value the goodwill of Hari Private Ltd.
The following additional information is supplied to you:
(a) Hari Private was incorporated on 1st January, 1986 and its first accounts were made
upto 31st December, 1986.
(b) It manufactures abrasive materials involving technical skill and it has engaged two
foreign experts since 1986.
(c) No provision for taxation is required.
(d) The fixed assets of the company have been adequately depreciated.
(e) The present market value of its Land and Building is Rs. 5,00,000 and of Plant and
Machinery Rs. 6,00,000.
(f) The profits and losses of the company for the last 3 years after charging depreciation
and taxation, have been as follows:
Rs.
1992
1,01,000
1993
1,50,000
1994
1,69,000
(g) The sales of the company during last 3 year were Rs. 12,99,000 Rs. 13,77,000 and Rs.
18,22,000.
The reasonable return on capital invested in the class of business carried on by Hari
Private Ltd. is 10 per cent.
It may be assumed that the company will able to maintain its profits for the next few
years on the same level as in the past. Whatever appropriate, you may make further
suitable assumptions. All workings should from part of your answer.
(CA FINAL) (15 marks) (May, 1995)
229
Q.No.37)
STRONG Ltd. have approached you for valuation of their shares in the context of their
forthcoming share issue. The company was incorporated on 1.4.1991.
The following information is extracted from their annual reports for the last 3 years.
(Rs. Lakhs)
Year ended 31st March
1992
1993
200
700
20
80
300
600
nil
500
1994
Gross Fixed Assets
750
Accumulated Depreciation
150
Net Current Assets
750
Loans Cr.
400
Share Capital
Equity Shares of Rs. 10 each
400
500
500
Profit before tax
20
60
120
Preliminary Expenses C/F
30
20
10
It is understood that the company has implemented a major project in 1993 which has
started yielding results in 1993-94.
Practices of merchant bankers indicate that an average of values based on net assets and
on yield is normally adopted in such cases. The normal industry expectation of yield is
15%. Tax rate is 40%.
You are required to compute the value of the client companys equity shares on the basis
of the above information showing workings as necessary.
(CA FINAL) (NOV. 94)
Q.No.38)
Q.No.39)
Q.No.40)
230
TEST PAPER-IX
Q.No.41)
Illustration 13 Study Material Page 3.37
Q.No.42)
Illustration 15 Study Material Page 3.43
Q.No.43)
Illustration 16 Study Material Page 3.45
Q.No.44)
Illustration 17 Study Material Page 3.62
Q.No.45)
Yogesh Ltd. showed the following performance over 5 years ended 31 st March, 1997:
Ended
* Net Profit
Prior period
Remarks
31st March
before tax Rs.
adjustment Rs.
1993
4,00,000
(-)1,00,000 Relating to 1991-92
1994
3,50,000
(-)2,50,000 Relating equally to 1991-92
and 1992-93
1995
6,50,000
(+)1,50,000 Relating to 1993-94
1996
5,50,000
(-)1,75,000 Relating to 1993-94
1997
6,00,000
(-)1,00,000 Relating to 1993-94
(+) 25,000 Relating to 1995-96
* Net profit before tax is after debiting or crediting the figures of loss (-) or Gains
(+) mentioned under the columns for prior period adjustments.
The net worth of the business as per the balance sheet of 31st March, 1992 is Rs.
6,00,000 backed by 10,000 fully paid equity shares of Rs. 10 each. Reserves and surplus
constitution the balance net worth. Yogesh Ltd. has not declared any dividend till date.
You are asked to value equity shares on:
(a)
Yield basis as on 31.3.1997. Assuming:
(i) 40% rate of tax.
(ii) anticipate after tax yield of 20%.
(iii) Differential weightage of 1 to 5 being given for the five years starting on
1.4.1992 for the actual profits of the respective years.
(b)
Net asset basis as per corrected balance sheet for each of the six years ended
31.3.1997.
Looking to the performance of the company over the 5 years period, would
you invest in the company?
(CA FINAL) (MAY, 97) (15 marks).
231
Q.No.46)
On the basis of the following information, calculate the value of goodwill of Gee Ltd. at
three years purchase of super profits, if any, earned by the company in the previous four
completed accounting years.
Balance Sheet of Gee Ltd. as at 31st March, 2004
Liabilities
Share Capital:
5 crore equity shares
of Rs. 10 each, fully paid up
Capital Reserve
General Reserve
Profit & Loss
(appropriation) A/c
Trade Creditors
Provision for Taxation (net)
Proposed Dividend for 20022003
Total
Rs. In
Lakhs
5,000
260
2,543
477
568
22
750
Assets
Goodwill
Land and buildings
Machinery
Furniture and Fixtures
Patents and Trade Marks
9% Non-trading Investments
Stock
Debtors
Cash in hand and at Bank
Preliminary Expenses
9,620 Total
Rs. In
Lakhs
310
1,850
3,760
1,015
32
600
873
614
546
20
9,620
The profits before tax for the four years have been as follows:
Year ended 31st March
2000
2001
2002
2003
The rate of income tax for the accounting year 1999-2000 was 40%. Thereafter it
has been 38% for all the years so far. But for the accounting year 2003-2004 it will be
35%.
In the accounting year 1999-2000, the company earned an extraordinary income
of Rs. 1 crore due to a special foreign contract. In August, 2000 there was an earthquake
due to which the company lost property worth Rs. 50 lakhs and the insurance policy did
not cover the loss due to earthquake or riots.
9% Non-trading investments appearing in the above mentioned Balance Sheet
were purchased at par by the company on 1 st April, 2001.
The normal rate of return for the industry in which the company is engaged is
20%. Also note that the companys shareholders, in their general meeting have passed a
resolution sanctioning the directors an additional remuneration of Rs. 50 lakh every year
beginning from the accounting year 2003-2004.
(May, 2004 CA FINAL)
232
TEST PAPER-X
Q.No.47)
The following balances are extracted from the books of Raj Ltd., a real estate company,
on 31st March, 1996: (Rs. 000)
Dr.
Sales
Purchases of Materials
Share Capital Fully Paid
Land Purchased in the Year as Stock
Leasehold Premises
Creditors
Debtors
Directors Salaries
Wages
Work in Progress on 01.04.95
Sub-Contractors Cost
Equipment, Fixtures and Fittings at Cost on 01.04.95
Stock on 01.04.95
Profit and Loss Account, Credit Balance on 01.04.95
Secured Loans
Interest on Loan and Overdraft
Depreciation on Equipment on 01.04.95
Administration Expenses
Office Salaries
Bank over draft
Cr.
2760
1218
100
73
42
463
735
39
111
210
894
264
59
128
112
22
164
147
18
3832
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
105
3832
233
(h)
The company will provide 10% of the pre tax profit as bonus to employees in the
accounts before charging the bonus.
(i)
Income Tax to be provided at 50% of the profits.
You are required:
(i) to prepare the companys financial statements for the year ended 31st
March 1996 as near as possible to proper form of company final accounts,
and
(ii) to prepare a set of Notes accounts including significant accounting
polices.
Notes:Workings should form part of your answer.
Previous year figures can be ignored.
Figures are to be rounded off to a nearest thousand.
(CA FINAL) (NOV. 96) (20 Marks)
Q.No.48)
The following information has been extracted from the books of account of Jay Ltd. as at
31st March, 1995.
Administration Expenses
Cash at Bank and on Hand
Cash Received on Sale of Fittings
Long Term Loan
Investments
Depreciation on Fixtures, Fitting, Tools and Equipment
(1st April, 1994)
Distribution Costs
Factory Closure Costs
Fixtures, Fittings, Tools and Equipment at Cost
Profit & Loss Account (at 1st April, 1994)
Purchase of Equipment
Purchases of Goods for Resale
Sales (net of Excise Duty)
Share Capital (50,000 shares of Rs. 10 each fully paid)
Stock (at 1st April, 1994)
Trade Creditors
Trade Debtors
Dr.
Cr.
(Rs. 000)
(Rs. 000)
240
114
5
35
100
130
51
30
340
40
60
855
1,500
500
70
40
390
2,250
2,250
Additional Information:
(1)
The stock at 31st March, 1995 (valued at the lower of cost or net realizable value)
was estimated to worth Rs. 1,00,000.
(2)
Fixtures, Fittings, tools and equipments all related to administration. Depreciation
is charged at a rate of 20% per annum on cost. A full years depreciation is
charged in the year of acquisition, but no depreciation is charged in the year of
disposal.
234
During the year to 31st March, 1995, the Company purchased Rs. 60,000 of
equipment. It also sold some fittings (which had originally cost Rs. 30,000) for Rs.
5,000 and for which depreciation of Rs. 15,000 had been set aside.
(4)
The average Income Tax for the Company is 50%. Factory closure cost is to be
presumed as an allowable expenditure for Income tax purpose.
(5)
The company proposes to pay a dividend of 20% of Equity Shares.
Prepare Jay Ltd.s Profit & Loss Account for the year to 31st March, 1995 and Balance
Sheet as at that date in accordance with the Companies Act, 1956 in the Vertical Form
alongwith the Notes on Accounts containing only the significant accounting policies.
Details of the schedules are not required.
(CA FINAL) (MAY 96) (20 marks)
Q.No.49)
A Company was incorporated on 1st July, 1991 to take over the business of Mr. M as and
from 1st April, 1991. Mr. Ms Balance Sheet, as at that date was as under:
(3)
Liabilities
Trade Creditors
Capital
Rs.
Assets
36,000 Building
1,94,000 Furniture and Fittings
Debtors
Stock
Bank
2,30,000
Rs.
80,000
10,000
90,000
30,000
20,000
2,30,000
Debtors and Bank balances are to be retained by the vender and creditors are to be paid
off by him. Realisation of debtors will be made by the company on a commission of 5%
on cash collected. The company is no issue M with 10,000 equity shares of
Rs. 10 each, Rs. 8 per share paid up and cash of Rs. 56,000.
The company issued to the public for cash 20,000 equity shares of Rs. 10 each on which
by 31st March, 1992 Rs. 8 per share was called and paid up except in the case of 1,000
shares on which the third call of Rs. 2 per share had not been realized. In the case of 2000
shares, the entire face value of the shares had been realized. The share issue was under
written for 2% commission, payable in shares fully paid up.
In addition to the balances arising out of the above, the following were shown by
the books of accounts of the company on 31st March, 1992.
Rs.
6,000
10,000
12,000
48,000
1,60,000
48,000
3,20,000
4,60,000
235
Stock on 31st March, 1992 was Rs. 52,000 Depreciation at 10% on Furniture and Fittings
and at 5% on Building is to be provided. Collections from debtors belonging to the
vendor were Rs. 60,000 in the period.
Kindly prepare the Trading and Profit & Loss Account for the period ended 31st
March, 1992 of the limited company and its Balance Sheet as at that date.
(CA FINAL) (MAY 1994 25 Marks)
Q.No.50)
With a view to reducing establishment expenses and generally to effect economy in
working Divya Ltd. agreed to take over Pranav Ltd. as going concern, both companies
being engaged in the same trade.
Divya Ltd. was to pay the debentures and Liabilities of Pranav Ltd. and take over
the assets, the consideration being the issue by Divya Ltd. of 4,00,000 fully paid shares of
Rs. 10 each at par and payment of Rs. 3,00,000 in cash to Pranav Ltd. Divya Ltd. was to
pay the liquidation expenses, which amounted to Rs. 1,40,000.
The Balance in the Books of the respective companies, as on the date of
absorption are given hereunder:
Assets
Liabilities
Divya Ltd.
Pranav Ltd. Divya Ltd.
Pranav Ltd.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Authorised Capital
Issued Capital (Rs.)
----- 1,50,00,000
50,00,000
Unpaid Calls
50,000
10,000
----10% Debentures
----50,00,000
10,00,000
Land & Building
1,03,33000
35,68,200
----Goodwill
30,00,000
5,00,000
----Sundry Debtors & Crds.
7,24,000
3,98,400
8,34,200
4,36,200
Bank Balances
16,84,200
----2,00,000
Stock
17,92,600
7,85,200
----Plant & Machinery
38,76,800
16,43,900
----Bills Receivable
3,62,100
------Profit and Loss a/c Balance
----9,88,500
2,69,500
2,18,22,700
69,05,700 2,18,22,700
69,05,700
Assume that the absorption was duly effected but that the unpaid calls and a book
debt of Rs. 40,000 due to Pranav Ltd. proved irrecoverable.
Prepare the Realisation Account and Member Account in the books of Pranav Ltd.
and the Balance Sheet of Divya Ltd. after the absorption. Your working should form part
of the answer.
(CA FINAL) (15 marks)
(Nov., 95)
236
.No.51)
Ksha Ltd. and Yaa Ltd. are two companies. On 31st March, 1999 their Balance Sheet
were as under: (Rs. Crores)
Ksha Ltd
Rs.
Equity Share Capital of
Rs. 10 each fully paid up
Reserve and surplus:
Revenue reserves
Surplus
Owners funds
Loan funds
Total Sources
Yaa Ltd.
Rs.
Rs.
300
40
700
10
1000
400
2000
1300
750
1050
250
1300
600
700
1300
Rs.
200
20
425
5
700
300
1500
900
450
650
350
1000
400
600
1000
Ksha Ltd. has 2 divisions-very profitable division A and loss making division B. Yaa Ltd.
similarly has 2 division-very profitable division B and loss making division A.
The two companies decided to reorganize. Necessary approvals from creditors
and members and sanction by High Court have been obtained to the following scheme:
1.
Division B of Ksha Ltd. which has fixed assets costing Rs. 400 crores (written
down value Rs. 160 crores), Current assets Rs. 900 crores, Current liabilities Rs.
750 crores and loan funds of Rs. 200 crores is to be transferred at Rs. 125 crores
to Yaa Ltd.
2.
Division A of Yaa Ltd. which has fixed assets costing Rs. 500 crores
(depreciation Rs. 200 crores), Current assets Rs. 800 crores, Current liabilities Rs.
700 crores and loan funds of Rs. 250 crores is to be transferred at Rs. 140 crores
to Ksha Ltd.
3.
237
4.
The directors of each of the companies revalued the fixed assets taken over as
follows:
238
TEST PAPER- XI
Q.No.52)
The following are the Balance Sheets as at 31st December, 1991 of X Ltd. and Y Ltd.
X
Y
X
Y
Liabilities
Rs.
Rs.
Assets
Rs.
Rs.
Share Capital:
Goodwill
30,000
10,000
Equity Shares of
Machinery
1,50,000 1,00,000
Rs. 10 each
4,00,000
3,00,000 Stock
40,000
72,000
Reserve and surplus
60,000
80,000 Debtors
2,10,000 1,20,000
Creditors
40,000
30,000 Bank
60,000
90,000
Preliminary Exp.
10,000
18,000
Rs. 5,00,000
4,10,000
Rs. 5,00,000 4,10,000
Goodwill of the companies is to be valued of Rs. 50,000 and Rs. 40,000 respectively
Machinery of X is worth Rs 2,00,000 and of Y Rs. 90,000. Stock of Y has been shown at
90% of its cost.
It is decided that X will acquire Y, without liquidating the latter, by taking over its
business by issue of shares at the intrinsic value.
You are required to draft the Balance Sheet of the two companies after putting through
the scheme.
(CA Final) (Nov.92) (15 Marks)
239
Q.No.53)
It has been decided that PURU Ltd. will absorb the entire undertaking of SHO
Ltd. and THAM Ltd. as of 1.4.994. the outside shareholders in the latter companies are to
be issued equity shares in PURU Ltd. on the basis of an agreed issued price of Rs.20 per
share. For this purpose, the interests of such shareholders are to be determined according
to the intrinsic value of the shares of the respective companies. AN Ltd. is a subsidiary of
THAM Ltd. and is also to be merged into PURU Ltd. appropriately
The Balance Sheet of the companies as at 31.3.1994, stood as under:
(Rs. Lakhs)
PURU
SHO
THAM
Sources:
Shares Capital:
Equity Shares 10 each
1,500
1,000
800
Reserves
2,000
540
702
Loans
1,600
900
1,000
5,100
2,440
2,502
Uses
Land
200
100
50
Building
500
400
100
Machinery
1,500
800
Other Fixed Assets
400
100
Investments:
40 lakhs Shares of SHO
500
----20 lakhs Shares of THAM
300
----40 lakhs Shares of AN
----400
Other investments
100
----Net Current Assets
1,600
1,040
1,252
5,100
2,440
2,502
AN
400
400
700
1,500
10
200
--------740
1,500
For the purpose of the scheme, it is agreed to give effect to the following value
appreciation of the assets of the companies to be absorbed:
Land
Machinery 20%
In order to obtain the consent of the creditors of THAM Ltd., it becomes necessary to
accept a claim of Rs. 20 lakhs hitherto classified as contingent. 60% of the claim is
accepted by THAM Ltd. and the balance is to be settled by PURU Ltd.
You are required to:
(i) Compute the number of shares to be issued by PURU Ltd. to eligible outsiders, and
(ii) Show the Balance Sheet of PURU Ltd. after the absorption.
(CA FINAL) (20 marks) (Nov. 1994)
240
Q.No.54)
The following are the Balance Sheet of Major Ltd. and Minor Ltd. as on 31st December
1985.
Assets
Fixed Assets : Machinery
Furniture
Investment
Shares in Minor Ltd.
Shares in Major Ltd.
Assets:
Stock
Debtors
Cash at Bank
Liabilities
Issued, Subscribed, and Paid up capital
Equity Shares of Rs. 100
Each fully paid
Reserve and Surplus:
Profit & Loss Account
Current Liabilities and Provisions:
Sundry Creditors
Major Ltd.
Minor Ltd.
Rs.
Rs.
1,00,000
50,000
20,000
5,000
25,000
12,000
75,000
60,000
20,000
3,00,000
45,000
68,000
20,000
2,00,000
Rs.
Rs.
2,00,000
1,00,000
60,000
30,000
40,000
3,00,000
70,000
2,00,000
Major Ltd. holds 200 shares in Minor Ltd. and Minor Ltd. holds 100 shares in Major.
The two companies agree on amalgamation on the following basis:(1)
A new company is to be formed called Hind Ltd.
(2)
The Goodwill is valued for Major Ltd. Rs. 50,000 and for Minor Ltd.
Rs. 25,000.
(3)
The Shares of Hind Ltd. are of nominal value of Rs. 10 each.
Prepare:
(1)
Balance sheet of Hind Ltd. resulting from the merger.
(2)
Schedule showing fully the shareholdings therein attributable to share-holders
of Major Ltd. and Minor Ltd. All costs of amalgamation are to be ignored.
Q.No.55)
Q.No.56)
241
TEST PAPER-XII
Q.No.57)
The Balance Sheet of S Ltd. and H Ltd as on 30th June, 1997 were as follows:
Liabilities
Equity Share Capital
Reserve and Surplus
10% 25 lakhs Debentures of R. 100 each
Other Liabilities
Assets
Fixed Assets at cost
Less: Depreciation
Investment in H Ltd.
2 crores Equity Shares of Rs. 10
each at cost
10% 25 lakhs Debentures of Rs.100
each at cost
Current Assets
Less: Current Liabilities
200
100
(Rs. in crores)
H Ltd.
25
75
25
--125
S Ltd.
80
400
--120
600
100
75
50
25
32
24
800
356
56
300
444
200
100
600
125
In a scheme of absorption duly approved by the court, the assets of H Ltd. were taken
over at an agreed value of Rs. 130 crores. The liabilities were taken over at par. Outside
shareholders of H Ltd. were allotted equity shares in S Ltd. at a premium of Rs. 90 per
share in satisfaction of their claims in H Ltd. Fixed assets taken over from H Ltd. were
revalued at Rs. 40 crores.
(a)
Give journal entries in the books of S Ltd. to record the transactions.
(b)
Show the balance Sheet of S Ltd. after absorption of H Ltd.
CA FINAL (NOV. 97) (15 marks)
Q.No.58)
The Balance Sheet of Sunlight Co. Ltd. on 31st December, 1975 stood as follows:Share Capital:
Goodwill at cost
2,00,000
(1) 10,000 7% Cumulative
Plants & Machineries
Preference Shares of
(less depreciation)
18,00,000
Rs. 100 each
10,00,000 Stock
3,00,000
(2) 20,000 Equity Shares
Debtors
4,50,000
of Rs. 100 each
20,00,000 Preliminary Expenses,
6% Debentures
3,00,000 Commission, etc.
1,00,000
Sundry Creditors
4,00,000 Cash
1,50,000
Bank Overdraft
3,00,000 Profit & Loss A/c
10,00,000
40,00,000
40,00,000
(Pref. Dividends are in arrear for 2 years.)
242
The company in the past few years had suffered heavily due to slump and labour unrest
but since the last quarter of 1975 finds the conditions turning towards and hopes to earn a
revenue profit in future to release a reasonable dividend on equity share if adjusted to a
reduced value.
A re-organization was agreed to by all parties concerned and you are requested to frame
an external scheme of re-construction taking into consideration the following points of
agreement and results of revaluation:(1)
Creditors to forego Rs. 50,000.
(2)
Pref. shareholders to forego their claim for arrears of dividend and if loss to
Equity share holders tends to exceed 50% to lower their capital claim by 20%
at the maximum by reducing the nominal value in consideration of 9%
Dividend effective after re-organization.
(3)
Bank to convert the overdraft to a term loan to the extent as would raise the
current ratio to 2:1.
(4)
Debentures will be exchanged according to the existing terms and denomination.
(5)
Works, Plants and Machineries will be revalued at Rs. 15,00,000.
(6)
Debtors will be written off by Rs. 50,000 being bad.
(7)
Equity shares will be exchanged for the same number of Equity Shares in the
new Co. at a reduced denomination as would be warranted in the circumstances.
Your Scheme will show the necessary working re: the total loss and its distribution, the
reorganization of Shares and Debentures, the revision of working capital and a Performa
Balance Sheet of the new company. (CA FINAL) (20 marks) MAY1981
Q.No.59)
A Ltd. has become sick since a few years. The management feels that the company has
recently turned the corner. Balance Sheet of company as at 31st march, 1988 and other
relevant particulars are given below:Balance Sheet of A Ltd. as at 31st March, 1988
Liabilities
Equity share capital of
Rs. 10 fully paid up
6% Preference share
Capital of Rs. 100
fully paid up
9% Debentures of Rs.300
each fully paid
Trade Creditors
Expense Creditors
I
II
III
Rs.
Assets
Land & Building
6,00,000 Plant & Machinery
Stock
Sundry Debtors
2,00,000 Cash and Bank Balance
Profit & Loss A/c
3,00,000 Debit balance
4,00,000
50,000
15,50,000
Rs.
1,00,000
2,00,000
2,00,000
2,00,000
30,000
8,20,000
15,50,000
243
IV
Preference shares are to be reduced to Rs. 50 each, fully paid up, the rate of
preference dividend being raised proportionately.
V
Debentures are to be reduced to Rs. 200 each fully paid up the rate of interest being
raised proportionately.
VI Trade creditors and expense creditors will wait for payment and continue business
on existing terms if 20% of their dues is paid forthwith.
VII
Directors are willing to bring in Rs. 1,00,000 in the form of equity capital Rs.
20,000 is estimated expenditure for completing the formalities.
Some of the Directors want to go in for capital reduction and some other prefer
external reconstruction.
You are requested to prepare Reconstruction Account, Realization Account and
two sets of Balance Sheet as may be appropriate under the above alternative schemes
effect to the various indicated above.
(CA FINAL)
Q.No.60)
The Balance Sheet as at 31st March, 1992 of Sickness Ltd. was as under:
Liabilities
Rs.
Assets
Share Capital:
Fixed Assets
8,000 equity shares of
Goodwill at cost
Rs. 100 each, Rs. 50 per
Others
Share paid up
4,00,000
4,000 11% cumulative
Less: Depreciation
Preference shares of
Investments
Rs. 100 each, fully paid up 4,00,000 Stock in Trade
Premium received on
Sundry Debtors
Preference shares
40,000 Cash and Bank
General Reserve
60,000
Current Liabilities
3,10,000
12,10,000
Contingent liability not Provided: Preference dividends are in
including the year ended 31st March, 1992
Rs.
40,000
8,50,000
8,90,000
2,70,000
Rs.
6,20,000
25,000
2,10,000
2,55,000
1,00,000
12,10,000
a arrears for three years
The funds of the Company are sufficient to discharge its liabilities including Preference
Dividends in arrears. However, the Company does not want to deplete its resources. It
would also like to reflect the values of some of its assets in a realistic manner. The Board
of Directors of the Company decided and proposed the following scheme of rehabilitation
/ reconstruction to be effective from 1st April, 1992.
(i)
(ii)
244
(iii)
(iv)
(v)
(vi)
(vii)
After the issue of the equity shares mentioned in (ii) above, the paid up value
of all the equity shares is to be reduced to Rs. 25 each.
The face value of all the equity shares to be reduced to Rs. 50 each and the
balance of the unpaid portion is to be called up fully.
Goodwill has lost its value and has to be written off. Market value of other
fixed assets is determined, as at 31st March, 1992, at Rs. 5,00,000.
Investments have no market value and have to be written off.
Stock in trade is to be valued at 110% of its book value and Sundry Debtors
are to be discounted by 5%.
The scheme, as approved by the Directors, is duly accepted by all authorities and
put into effect.
During the working for the half year ended 30th September, 1992, it is noticed that
the trading for the period has resulted in an increase of bank balances by Rs. 55,100, Drs.
by Rs. 40,000, Crs. by Rs. 26000 and stock reduced by Rs. 8,000. Depreciation for the
half year on fixed assets at 10% per annum is to be provided. The increase in the bank
balances was prior to the company paying the half yearly interest on the debentures and
redeeming one half of the debentures on 30th September, 1992.
From the above information, you are required to prepare the Balance Sheet of
Sickness Ltd. as at 30th September 1992.
All working notes, including journal entries, ledger accounts etc. are to form part
of your answer.
(CA FINAL) (20 marks) (May, 1993)
Q.No.61)
A Ltd. decided to re-organise its structure following a period of adverse trading
conditions. The Balance Sheet of the company as on 31st March 1992, showed the
following:
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Share Capital:
Fixed Assets:
20,000 8%
Goodwill
55,000
Cumulative
Freehold property at
Preference Share of
cost
60,000
Rs. 10 each
2,00,000 Leasehold property
at cost
15,000 Equity
1,40,000
Less:
Dep.
Shares of Rs. 10 each
1,50,000
18,000 1,22,000
Share Premium
Plant & Machinery
Account
2,20,000
5,000 at cost
Less: Dep.
60,000 1,60,000
9% Debentures
(Secured on
3,97,000
Freehold property)
60,000
Trade Investment
40,000
Add: Accrued Int.
2,700
62,700 Current Assets:
Creditors
85,000 Stock
30,000
Bank Overdraft
96,000 Debtors
60,000
90,000
Preliminary Exp.
2,500
Profit & Loss A/c
69,200
5,98,700
5,98,700
245
Note: Preference Dividends are in arrears for four years.
Subsequent to approved by the Court of a scheme for the reduction of capital, the
following steps were taken:
(i)
The Preference Share were reduced to Rs. 7.5 per share, and the Equity Shares
to Rs. 2.0 per share. After reduction, the shares were consolidated into Rs. 10
shares. The authorized capital was restored to 2,00,000 8% Cumulative
Preference Share and Rs. 1,50,000 Equity Shares, both of Rs. 10 each.
(ii)
I new Equity hare of Rs. 10 was issued for every Rs. 40 of gross preference
dividend in arrears.
(iii)
The balance on share premium account was utilized.
(iv)
The debenture holders took over the freehold property at an agreed figure of
Rs. 75,000 and paid the balance to the company after deducing the amount due
to them.
(v)
Plant and Machinery was written down to Rs. 1,40,000
(vi)
Trade Investment was sold for Rs. 32,000.
(vii) Goodwill, Preliminary Expenses, Debts of Rs. 8,600 and obsolete stock of Rs.
10,000 were written off.
(viii) Contingent liability for which no provision had been made was settled at Rs.
7,000 and of the amount Rs. 6,300 was recovered from the insurers.
(ix)
Available cash is deposited in Bank Overdraft account.
You are required: (a) to show the Journal entries necessary to record the above
transactions in the companys books, (b) to show Capital Reduction Account and Cash
Account and (c) to prepare the Balance Sheet after completion of the scheme.
(CA FINAL) (20 marks) (May, 1992)
246
TEST PAPER- XIII
Q.No.62)
Q.No.63)
Hamer Limited and Grace Limited proposed to amalgamate:
Their Balance Sheets as on December 31st 1981 were:
Liabilities
Share Capital:
Equity Share of
Rs. 10 each
Reserves and
Surplus :
General Reserve
Profit & Loss
Account
Current
Liabilities
Creditors
Total
Hamer
Ltd. Rs.
5,00,000
2,00,000
1,00,000
1,00,000
9,00,000
Grace
Ltd. Rs.
Assets
Fixed Assets
(Less Depreciation)
2,00,000 Investment
(Face value Rs.
1,00,000 6% tax
free G.P. Notes)
20,000 Current Assets:
Stock
30,000
Debtors
Hamer
Ltd. Rs.
4,00,000
Grace
Ltd. Rs.
1,00,000
1,00,000
2,00,000
1,30,000
1,70,000
60,000
30,000
10,000
9,00,000
3,00,000
50,000
Cash and Bank
Balance
3,00,000 Total
Hamer Ltd.
Rs.
1,30,000
1,25,000
1,50,000
Grace Ltd.
Rs.
45,000
40,000
56,000
Goodwill may be taken as 4 years purchase of average super profits trading on the basis
of 15% normal trading profit on closing Capital invested. The stock of Hamer Ltd. and
Grace Ltd. to be taken at Rs. 2,04,000 & Rs. 1,42,000 respectively for the purpose of
amalgamation. X Ltd. is formed for the purpose of amalgamation of both the companies.
Advise upon Capitalisation of X Ltd. and suggest a scheme of exchange of shares for that
purpose.
Draft of Balance Sheet of X Limited
247
Q.No.64)
XYZ Ltd. was incorporated to take over X Ltd., Y Ltd. and Z Ltd. on the basis of their
Balance Sheets as on 31.3.87 subject to the following terms and conditions.
(1)
Goodwill is to be valued at three years purchase of average super profit for
three years. Such average is to be calculated after adjustment of depreciation
at 10% on the amount increase/decrease on revaluation of fixed assets. Income
tax is to be ignored.
(2)
Assets are to be revalued.
(3)
Normal Profit on capital employed is to be taken at 10%, capital employed
being considered on the basis of net revaluation amounts of tangible assets.
(4)
Equity Shares of Rs. 10 each fully paid on in XYZ Ltd. are to be distributed in
the ratio average profit adjustment of depreciation on revaluation as started in
(1) above.
(5)
10% Debentures of Rs. 100 each fully paid-up are to be issued by XYZ Ltd.
for the balance due.
(6)
Issue of Equity Shares and Debentures for this purpose is to be in the ratio of
3:1.
The summarised Balance Sheet as at 31.3.87 and the relevant information are given
below:
X Ltd.
Assets
Net Tangible Block
Goodwill
Current Assets
Liabilities
Equity Share
Capital (Rs. 10 each)
Reserves
10% Debentures
Trade and Expense Creditors
Rs.
8,00,000
3,00,000
11,00,000
X Ltd.
Rs.
Y Ltd.
Rs.
6,00,000
50,000
2,50,000
9,00,000
Y Ltd.
Rs.
Z Ltd.
Rs.
5,00,000
1,00,000
6,00,000
Z Ltd.
Rs.
6,00,000
1,00,000
2,00,000
2,00,000
11,00,000
7,00,000
50,000
1,50,000
9,00,000
3,00,000
1,00,000
1,00,000
1,00,000
6,00,000
10,00,000
3,50,000
5,00,000
1,40,000
6,00,000
80,000
1,80,000
1,44,000
78,000
Calculate the number of Equity Shares and Debentures to be issued to each of the
companies.
248
(b)
AB Ltd.
MB Ltd.
7,50,000 2,00,000
3,50,000
---
--- 5,00,000
4,00,000 1,00,000
15,00,000 8,00,000
249
Calculate the amount of purchase consideration for AB Ltd. and MB Ltd. and draw up
the balance sheet of AM Ltd. after considering the following:
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Also show, how the investment allowance reserve will be treated in the Financial
Statement assuming the Reserve will be maintained for 3 years.
(CA FINAL) (MAY 99) (16 marks)
250
TEST PAPER-XIV
Q.No.67)
On 1st Nov., 1998 Yash Ltd. was incorporated with an authorities capital of Rs.
1,000 crores. It issued to its promoters equity capital of Rs. 50 crores which was paid for
in full. On that day it purchased the running business of Vijay Ltd. for Rs. 200 crores and
allotted at par equity capital of Rs. 200 crores in discharge of the consideration. The net
assets taken over from Vijay Ltd. were valued as follows: Fixed assets Rs. 150 crores,
Inventory Rs. 10 crores, Customers dues Rs. 70 crores and Creditors Rs. 30 crores.
Yash Ltd. carried on business and the following information is furnished to you:
(a) Summary of cash/bank transactions (for year ended 31 st October, 1999)
Rs. In Cr.
Rs. In Cr.
Equity capital raised:
Promoters (as shown above)
50
Others
250
300
Collections from customers
4,000
Sale proceeds of fixed assets (cost Rs. 18 Cr.)
20
4,320
Payments to suppliers
2,000
Payments to employees
700
Payments to expenses
500
3,200
Investments in Upkar Ltd.
100
Payments to suppliers of fixed assets:
Instalment due
600
Interest
50
650
Tax payment
270
Dividend
50
Closing cash/bank balance
50
4,320
(b) On 31st October, 1999 Yash Ltd.s assets and liabilities were:
Inventory at cost
Customers dues
Prepaid expenses
Advances to suppliers
Amounts due to suppliers of goods
Amount due to suppliers of fixed assets
Outstanding expenses
(c) Depreciation for the year under:
(i) Companies Act, 1956
(ii) Income-tax for Act, 1961
Rs. In Cr.
15
400
10
40
260
750
30
Rs. 180 Cr.
Rs. 200 Cr.
251
(d) Provide for tax at 38.5% of total income. There are no disallowables for the purpose
of income taxation. Provision for tax is to be rounded off. Yash Ltd. asks you to
prepare:
(i) Revenue statement for the year ended 31 st October, 1999 and
(ii) Balance Sheet as on 31st October, 1999, from the above information.
(Nov. 99 CA FINAL) (20 marks)
Q.No.68)
The summarised Balance Sheets of R Ltd. and P Ltd. for the year ending on 31.3.2000
are as under:
R Ltd.
P Ltd.
R Ltd.
P Ltd.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Equity Share Capital
Assets :
(in shares of
Fixed
55,00,000 27,00,000
Rs. 10 each)
24,00,000 12,00,000 Assets
8% Preference Share
Current
25,00,000 23,00,000
Capital (in shares
Assets
of Rs. 10 each)
8,00,000
10% Preference Share
Capital (in shares
Of Rs. 10 each)
--4,00,000
Reserves
30,00,000 24,00,000
Current Liabilities
18,00,000 10,00,000
80,00,000 50,00,000
80,00,000 50,00,000
The following information is provided:
R Ltd.
P Ltd.
Rs.
Rs.
(1)
(a) Profit before tax
10,64,000
4,80,000
(b) Taxation
4,00,000
2,00,000
(c) Preference dividend
64,000
40,000
(d) Equity dividend
2,88,000
1,92,000
(2)
The equity shares of both the companies are quoted in the market. Both the
companies are carrying on similar manufacturing operations.
(3)
R Ltd. proposes to absorb P Ltd. as on 31.3.2000. The terms of absorption are as
under:
(a) Preference shareholders of P Ltd. will receive 8% preference shares of R
Ltd. sufficient to increase the income of preference shareholder of P Ltd.
by 10%.
(b) The equity shareholders of P Ltd. will receive equity shares of R Ltd. on
the following basis:
(i)
The equity shares of P Ltd. will be valued by applying to the
earnings per share of P Ltd. 75% of price earnings ratio of
R Ltd. based on the results of 1999-2000 of both the companies.
(ii)
The market price of equity shares of R Ltd. is Rs. 40 per share.
(iii)
The number of shares to be issued to the equity shareholders of
P Ltd. will be based on the above market value.
(iv)
In addition to equity shares, 8% preference shares of R Ltd. will be
issued to the equity shareholders of P Ltd. to make up for the loss
252
in income arising from the above exchange of shares based on the
dividends for the year 1999-2000.
(4)
The assets and liabilities of P Ltd. as on 31.3.2000 are revalued by professional
valuer as under:Increased by
Decreased by
Rs.
Rs.
Fixed Assets
1,00,000
--Current Assets
--2,00,000
Current Liabilities
--40,000
(5)
For the next two years, no increase in the rate of equity dividend is expected.
You are required to:
(i)
Set out in detail the purchase consideration.
(ii)
Give the Balance Sheet as on 31.3.2000 after absorption.
Note: Journal entries are not required.
(Nov.2000 CA FINAL)
Q.No.69)
The following are the Balance Sheets of RS Ltd. and XY Ltd. as on 31.3.2002.
Rs. in 000s
Liabilities
RS
XY
Assets
RS
XY
Ltd.
Ltd.
Ltd.
Ltd.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Rs.
Shares Capital:
Fixed Assets net of 2,700
850
depreciation
Equity shares of Rs.
100 each fully paid up 2,000
1,00 Investments
700
--Reserves and Surplus
800
--- Sundry Debtors
400
150
10% Debentures
500
--- Cash & Bank
250
--Loan from Financial
Profit and Loss Account
--800
Institutions
250
400
Bank Overdraft
--100
Sundry Creditors
300
300
Proposed Dividend
200
--Total
4,050 1,800 Total
4,050
1,800
It was decided that XY Ltd. will acquire the business of RS Ltd. for enjoying the
benefit of carry forward of business loss. After acquisition, XY Ltd. will be renamed as
XYZ Ltd. The following scheme has been approved for the merger:
(i)
XY Ltd. will reduce its shares to Rs. 10 and then consolidate 10 such shares
into one shares of Rs. 100 each (New share).
(ii)
Financial institutions agreed to waive 15% of the loan of XY Ltd.
(iii)
Shareholders of RS Ltd. will be given one new share of XY Ltd. in exchange
of every share held in RS Ltd.
(iv)
RS Ltd. will cancel 20% holding of XY Ltd. Investments were held at Rs.
250 thousands.
(v)
After merger the proposed dividend of RS Ltd. will be paid to the
shareholders of RS Ltd.
253
(vi)
(vii)
Q.No.70)
The Balance Sheet of Z Ltd. as 31st March, 2003 is given below. In it, the respective
shares of the companys two divisions namely S Division and W Division in the
various assets and liabilities have also been shown.
(All amounts in crores of Rupees)
S Division
W Division Total
Fixed Assets:
Cost
875
249
Less: Depreciation
360
81
Written-down value
515
168
683
Investments
97
Net Current assets:
Current Assets
445
585
Less: Current Liabilities
270
93
175
492
667
1,447
Financed by:
Loan funds
15
417
Own Funds:
Equity share capital: shares of Rs. 10 each
345
Reserves and surplus
685
1,447
Loan funds included, inter alia, Bank Loans of Rs. 15 crore specifically taken for
W division and Debentures of the paid up value of Rs. 125 crore redeemable at any time
between 1st October, 2002 and 30th September, 2003.
On 1st April, 2003 the company sold all of its investments for Rs. 102 crore and
redeemed all the debentures at par, the cash transactions being recorded in the Bank
Account pertaining to S Division.
Then a new company named Y Ltd. was incorporated with an authorized capital
of Rs. 900 crore divided into shares of Rs. 10 each. All the assets and liabilities
pertaining to W Division were transferred to the newly formed company; Y Ltd. allotting
to Z Ltd.s shareholders its two fully paid equity shares of Rs. 10 each at par for every
fully paid equity shares of Rs. 10 each held in Z Ltd. as discharge of consideration for the
division taken over.
Y Ltd. recorded in its fixed assets at Rs. 218 crore and all other assets and
liabilities at the same values at which they appeared in the books of Z Ltd.
You are required to:
(i)
Show the journal entries in the books of Z Ltd.
254
(ii)
(iii)
(iv)
Prepare Z Ltd.s Balance Sheet immediately after the demerger and the initial
Balance Sheet of Y Ltd. (Schedules in both cases need not be prepared).
Calculate the intrinsic value of one share of Z Ltd. immediately before the
demerger and immediately after the demerger; and
Calculate the gain, if any, per share to the shareholders of Z Ltd. arising out of
the demerger.
MAY 2004 CA FINAL)
Q.No.71)
ABC Ltd. was incorporated in 1/5/2003 to take over the business of DEF and Co. from
1/1/2003. The Profit and Loss Account as given by ABC Ltd. for the year ending
31/12/2003 is as under:
Profit and Loss Account
Rs.
Rs.
To Rent and Taxes
90,000 By Gross Profit
10,64,000
To Salaries including Managers
By Interest on
salary of Rs. 85,000
3,31,000 Investments
36,000
To Carriage Outwards
14,000
To Printing and Stationery
18,000
To Interest on Debentures
25,000
To Sales Commission
30,800
To Bad Debts
(related to sales)
91,000
To Underwriting Commission
26,000
To Preliminary Expenses
28,000
To Audit Fees
45,000
To Loss on Sale of Investment
11,200
To Net Profit
3,90,000
11,00,000
11,00,000
Prepare a Statement showing allocation of pre-incorporation and post incorporation
profits after considering the following information:
(i)
G.P. ratio was constant throughout the year.
(ii)
Sales for January an October were 1 times the average monthly sales while
sales for December were twice the average monthly sales.
(iii)
Bad Debts are shown after adjusting a recovery of Rs. 7,000 of Bad Debt for a
sale made in July, 2000.
(iv)
Managers salary was increased by Rs. 2,000 pm from 1/5/2003.
(v)
All investments were sold in April, 2003.6
(MAY 2004 CA FINAL)
255
Q.No.72)
Travels & Tours Ltd. has two divisions Inland and International. The Balance Sheet
as at 31st December, 2004 was as under:
Inland
International
Total
(Rs. crores) (Rs. crores) (Rs. crores)
Fixed Assets:
Cost
600
600
1,200
Depreciation
500
200
700
W.D.V. (written down value)
100
400
500
Net Current Assets:
Current assets
400
300
700
Less: Current liabilities
200
200
400
200
100
300
Total
300
500
800
Financed by:
Loan Funds
(Secured by a charge on fixed assets)
--100
100
Own Funds:
Equity capital (fully paid up Rs.10 shares)
50
Reserves and surplus
650
?
?
700
Totals
300
500
800
It is decided to form a new company IT Ltd. for international tourism to take
over the assets and liabilities of international division.
Accordingly IT Ltd. was formed to takeover at Balance Sheet figures the assets
and liabilities of international division. IT Ltd. is to allot 5 crore equity shares of Rs. 10
each in the company to the members of Travels & Tours Ltd. in full settlements of the
consideration. The members of Travels & Tours Ltd. are therefore to become members of
IT Ltd. as well without having to make any further investment.
(a)
You are asked to pass journal entries in relation to the above in the books of
Travels & Tours Ltd. and also in IT Ltd.. Also show the Balance Sheets of
both the companies as on 1st January, 2005 showing corresponding figures, before
the reconstruction also.
(b)
The directors of both the companies ask you to find out the net asset value of
shares pre- and post-demerger. (c)Comment on the impact of demerger on
Shareholders wealth. (MAY 2005 CA FINAL)
Test Paper XV
Go through the following theory topics : Mutual Funds, Merchant Bankers, Accounting
by Stock Brokers, NBFC, Futures and options, Corporate Social reporting, Corporate
Governance, ESPP, ESOP and Environment accounting.
256
Solutions to Test Paper I ( Advanced Accounting )
Q.NO. 1 : Analysis of profit of B Ltd 31.3.1981
Capital profit
(pre- 1st April,
1980)
General reserve 1.4.1980
P & L a/c 1.4.1980
Less dividend for year ended 31.3.1980
Profit for year ended 31.3.1981
Less interim dividend
Total
Holding companys share ( 90%)
20,000
22,000
9,000
12,000
-4,500
Cost of control :
Cost of shares of B Ltd as held by A Ltd.
Less pre acquisition dividend
Paid up value of such shares
As share in capital profit of B
Goodwill
13,000
33,000
33,000 x 0.90
= 29,700
33,000 x 0.10
= 3,300
Revenue
profit
( 1.4.1980
31.3.1981)
: 6,000
3,300
750
7,500
7,500
7,500 x 0.90
= 6,750
7,500 x 0.10
= 750
10,050
1,10,000
- 8,100 ( 9,000 x 0.90)
- 54,000
-29,700
18,200
Amount
44,200
1,90,000
46,000
44,100
3,24,300
*Total investments of A =
1,56,000
Less shares of B ( 110000 8100)**
-1,01,900
Less debentures of B ( Assumption : cost = paid up value )
-10,000
Other investments of A
44,100
** Purchased for Rs. 1,10,000 , later on pre-acquisition dividend was received and
credited to Investment a/c ( see item No. 4 of the question)
257
Q.NO. 2 : Analysis of profit of S Ltd 31.3.1984
Capital profit
(pre- 1st April,
1983)
General reserve 1.4.1983
Less bonus shares
P & L a/c 1.4.1983
Less dividend for year ended 31.3.1983
Profit for year ended 31.3.1984
Total
Holding companys share ( 60%)
Minoritys share (40%)
Minority Interest :
Paid up value of shares held by minority
+ Minority s share in capital profit
+ Minority s share in revenue profit
Cost of control :
Cost of shares of S Ltd as held by H Ltd.
Less pre acquisition dividend
Paid up value of such shares
Hs share in capital profit of S
Capital reserve
5,00,000
-2,00,000
2,00,000
1,00,000
Revenue
profit
( 1.4.1983
31.3.1984)
3,00,000
1,00,000
4,00,000
2,40,000
1,60,000
2,00,000
2,00,000
1,20,000
80,000
5,00,000
-60,000
- 4,20,000
-2,40,000
2,20,000
Amount
17,00,000
18,60,000
35,60,000
258
Q. No. 3 : Assumption : A Ltd. acquired 8000 shares of Omega (before Omegas bonus
issue) on cum-bonus basis. In other words, on 31st DEC. 1994, A Ltd. purchased 8000
shares and got 4000 shares of Omega.
Note : There is an error of omission in the books of Omega. Omega is to get Rs. 100
interest from A Ltd. This transaction has not been recorded in the books of Omega.
Before preparing the consolidated B/S, we should rectify this error. This will, on one
hand, increase the P & L a/c balance of Omega by Rs. 100 and, on the other hand, the
amount of Loan to A Ltd. ( as appearing in the B/S of Omega) will also increase by Rs.
100.
Analysis of profit of Omega Ltd. 31.12.1994
Capital profit
(up to 31.12.94 )
CAPITAL reserve 31.12.94
52,000
Less bonus shares
-50,000
General reserve 31.12.94
P & L a/c 31.12.94
Revaluation loss 31.12.94
Total
Holding co. s share
Minority interest
Minority interest :
Paid up value of shares held by minority
+ Minority s share in capital profit
2,000
5,000
18,100
-5,000
20,100
16,080
4,020
:
Cost of control :
Cost of shares of Omega a held by A :
Less : (i) paid up value of shares of Omega as held
by A (including bonus shares)
(ii) A share in capital profit of Omega
Goodwill
1,70,000
-1,20,000
-16,080
33,920
Amount
3,00,000
25,000
38,200
1,500
22,900
34,020
4,21,620
Assets
Goodwill
FA
Stock
B/R less inter-co. Owings
Drs.
Bank
Total
Amount
33,920
2,89,700
60,000
1,000
30,000
7,000
4,21,620
259
Q. No. 4 : Notes (i): There is an error of omission in the books of B. B is to get Rs.
1,000 interest from A Ltd. This transaction has not been recorded in the books of B.
Before preparing the consolidated B/S, we should rectify this error. This will, on one
hand, increase the P & L a/c balance of B by Rs. 1,000 and, on the other hand, the
amount of Loan to A Ltd. ( as appearing in the B/S of B) will also increase by Rs.
1,000.
(ii) General Reserve and capital reserve balances have been brought down from last year.
Analysis of profit of B Ltd. as on 31st March, 1992
Capital profit
(pre- 1.10. 91)
5,50,000
-5,00,000
Minority interest :
Paid up capital ( including bonus shares )
Capital profit
Revenue
50,000
21,000
80,000
50,000
-50,000
1,51,000
1,20,800
30,200
3,00,000
30,200
16,000
Cost of control :
shares
up value of shares including bonus shares
Holding co.s share in capital profit of B
Revenue
profit
( 1.10.91
31.3.92)
17,00,000
-12,00,000
- 1,20,800
80,000
80,000
64,000
16,000
3,46,200
Cost of
Paid
3,79,200
Consolidated B/S of A Ltd and its subsidiary B Ltd. as on 31st March, 1992
Liabilities
Share capital
General reserve
P & L a/c 3,82,000 +64,000
B/P less inter co. Owings
Crs.
Minority interest
Total
Amount
30,00,000
3,00,000
4,46,000
12,000
2,49,000
3.46.200
43,53,200
Assets
Goodwill
FA
Stock
B/R less inter-co. Owings
Drs.
Bank
Total
Amount
3,79,200
28.97,000
6,00,000
7,000
4,30,000
40,000
43,53,200
260
Q.No. 5 : Analysis of profit of Moon Ltd 31.3.2000
Capital profit
(pre- 1.4.97)
Revenue
profit ( GR)
( 1.4.1997
31.3.2000)
Revenue profit
(P & L a/c)
( 1.4.1997
31.3.2000)
10,000
6,000
6,000
Profit 1.4.1997-31.3.2000
Revaluation loss
-12,000
Dep written back (1.4.97-31.3.2000)
Total
4,000
Holding co.s share
3,200
Minority s share
800
Cost of control :
Cost of shares
88,000
Pre- acquisition dividend
-8,000
Capital profit
-3,200
Paid up capital
-96,000
Capital reserve
19,200
Minority interest :
Paid up capital ( including bonus)
24,000
Capital profit
800
Revenue profit
1,200
Revenue profit
3,520
14,000
3,600
17,600
14,080
3,520
6,000
4,800
1,200
29520
Consolidated B/S of Sun Ltd. and its subsidiary Moon Ltd. 31.3.2000
Liabilities
Amount
Assets
Share capital
1,20,000
FA
General reserve 20000+4800
24,800
Stock
P & L a/c
18,080* B/R less inter-co. Owings
Capital reserve
19,200
Drs. less inter-co. Owings
B/P less inter co. Owings
5,000
Bank
Crs. less inter-co. Owings
9,000
Bank in transit
Minority interest
29,520
Total
2,25,600
Total
Contingent liability for Bill discounted Rs. 1,000.
* P & L of Holding
Less pre- acquisition dividend
Add share in post acquisition P & L of subsidiary
12,000
-8,000
14,080
18,080
Amount
1,19,600
50,000
18,000
17,000
19,000
2,000
2,25,600
261
Solutions to Test Paper II ( Advanced Accounting )
Answer to Q.NO.6 :
[capital + profit loss] 30% of [capital + profit loss]
1.1.93 10,80,000
3,24,000
31.12.93 8,30,000
2,49,000
31.12.94 4,30,000
1,29,000
31.12.95
-70,000
-21,000
31.12.96 -1,90,000
-57,000
31.12.97 -1,40,000
-42,000
31.12.98
-40,000
-12,000
31.12.99 1,10,000
33,000
Minority interest
3,24,000
2,49,000
1,29,000
Nil
Nil
Nil
Nil
33,000
Amount
25.00
95.00
125.00
20.65
265.65
Assets
Goodwill*
FA
Investment
Net CA
Total
* COST OF SHARES
Book value on the date of acquisition: X Invest.
Book value on the date of acquisition: Y
Book value on the date of acquisition: Z
Goodwill
**Minority interest = (25 x 0.49) + ( 35 x 0.24) = 20.65
Amount
5.65
46.00
29.00
185.00
265.65
50
-5
-25 x 0.51
-35 x 0.76
5.65
262
Working notes to Q. No. 9 Analysis of profit of S Ltd. 31.3.1990
General reserve
30000
9000
21000
Total
Minoritys share
Holding companys share
P & L a/c
40000
12000
28000
6500
3800
Post-acquisition P & L
24200
Cost of control :
Cost of shares
Paid up capital
Capital profit
Capital profit
Pre-acquisition dividend
Goodwill
Minority interest :
Paid up capital 30,000
GR
9,000
P&L
12,000
1,00,000
-70,000
-14,500
-3,800
-2,000
9,700
51,000
263
Solutions to Test Paper III ( Advanced Accounting )
Answer to Q. No. 11 ( Assumption : Pref. shares are cumulative )
Analysis of profit of S Ltd 30th Sept. 1985
Capital profit
Revenue
(pre- 1.10.84)
profit ( GR)
( 1.10.1984
30.9.85)
General reserve 1.10.84
Less bonus shares
50,000
-50,000
Revenue
profit
(P & L a/c)
( 1.10.1984
30.9.85)
Nil
60,000
6,000
84,000
84,000
6,000
78,000
6000x0.80 +
78000x0.80
=67,200
Minoritys share
6,000 x 0.20 = 60,000 x 0.20 6000x0.20 +
=1,200
= 12,000
78000 x 0.20
16,800
* Preference dividend 12% on Rs.50,000 and 12% equity dividend on Rs.1,50,000
Cost of control :
Cost of shares
3,80,000
Paid up capital ( E ) (including bonus )
-1,60,000
Paid up capital ( P)
- 40,000
Pre-acquisition dividend (80% of 24000)
- 19,200
Capital profit
- 4,800
Goodwill
1,56,000
6,000
6,000
6,000 x 0.80
=4,800
60,000
60,000
60,000 x 0.80
=48,000
Minority interest : Paid up capital (E) including Rs. 10,000 bonus shares
Paid up ( pref.)
Capital profit
Revenue profit (GR)
Revenue profit ( P & L )
Rs. 40,000
Rs. 10,000
Rs. 1,200
Rs. 12,000
Rs. 16,800
Rs. 80,000
264
Consolidated B/S of H Ltd and its subsidiary S Ltd as on 30.9.1985
Liabilities
Amount
Assets
Amount
E. Share capital
5,00,000
Goodwill
2,56,000
P. Share capital
1,00,000
Machinery
1,60,000
G. reserve 100000 +48000
1,48,000
Vehicle
2,50,000
P & L a/c
1,94,000*
Furniture
80,000
Creditors 130000-20000
1,10,000
Stock 210000 4000
2,06,000
Tax
1,30,000
Drs. 265000-20000
2,45,000
Minority interest
80,000
Bank
65,000
Total
12,62,000
Total
12,62,000
*Holding co.s P & L Balance 1,50,000 + Hs share in post acquisition profit of S
Rs. 67.200 Stock reserve 4000 pre-acquisition dividend 19,200 = 1.94.000
Answer to Q. No. 12
Assumption : H acquired 80% shares in A and A acquired 75% shares in B on the same
date.
Analysis of profit of B Ltd 31st Dec. 1983
Capital profit
Revenue
Revenue profit
profit ( GR) (P & L a/c)
General reserve
20,000
40,000
P&L
40,000
20,000
Total
60,000
40,000
20,000
As share
45,000
30,000
15,000
Minority s share
15,000
10,000
5,000
Analysis of profit of A Ltd 31st Dec. 1983
Capital profit
General reserve
P&L
As share in post acquisition profit of B
Total
Hs share
Minoritys share
40,000
80,000
Nil
1,20,000
96,000
24,000
Cost of control
Cost of shares (1,50,000 + 60,000)
Paid up capital (1,60,000 + 75,000)
Capital profit (B)
Capital profit (A)
CR
Minority interest : Paid up 40,000 + 25,000
B profit 15000+10000+5000
As profit 24,000+10,000+11,000
Revenue
profit ( GR)
20,000
30,000
50,000
40,000
10,000
Revenue profit
(P & L a/c)
40,000
15,000
55,000
44,000
11,000
2,10,000
-2,35,000
- 45,000
- 96,000
1,66,000
65,000
30,000
45,000 140000
265
Consolidated B/S of H Ltd and its subsidiaries A Ltd & B Ltd. as on 30.9.1985
Liabilities
Amount
Assets
Amount
S. capital
10,00,000
FA
10,20,000
Reserve 1,00,000 + 40,000
1,40,000
Stock
8,90,000
P & L a/c 4,00,000 + 44,000
4,44,000
Drs.
3,80,000
Capital reserve
1,66,000
Creditors
3,80,000
B/P
20,000
M. Int.
1,40,000
Total
22,90,000
Total
22,90,000
Answer to Q. No. 13
Analysis of profit of RAHIM as on 31.3.91
Capital profit
Revenue
(pre- 1.4.89)
profit
( 1.4.89
31.3.91)
P & L a/c
40,000
2,19,400
Rams share(90%)
36,000
1,97,460
Minoritys share (10%)
4,000
21,940
Profit of Ram ( i.e. Rams own profit and Rams share in post acquisition profit of Rahim)
30.9.88
Rams own P & L a/c
1,46,500
Rams share in post
Nil (Rahim was not subs. of
acquisition profit of Rahim Ram on this date
Total
1,46,500
Analysis of profit of RAM as on 31.3.91
Capital profit
P & L a/c
As share(62.50%)
Minoritys share (37.50%)
Minority interest : Paid up 60,000 + 10,000
Profit of Rahim 4000+21940
Profit of Ram
54,937 + 94,147
Cost of control :
Cost of shares
Paid up value
Capital profit
Capital profit
CR
3,10,000
-1,90,000
- 36,000
- 91,563
7,563
1,46,500
91,563
54,937
=
31.3.91
2,10,100
1,97,460
3,97,560
Revenue profit
2,51,060
1,56,913
94,147
70,000
25,940
1,49,084
2,45,024
266
Consolidated B/S of A Ltd and its subsidiaries Ram Ltd and Rahim Ltd as on 31.3.91
Liabilities
S. capital
P & L a/c
Share in post
acquisition profit
CR
M. Int.
Total
Amount
2,00,000
Assets
S. Assets
Amount
11,33,000
6,80,413
7,563
2,45,024
11,33,000
Total
11,33,000
5,23,500
+156913
267
Solutions to Test Paper IV ( Advanced Accounting )
Answer to Q. No. 16:
BALANCE-SHEETS AS ON 31.3.06
WAR
PEACE
ESC
10,50,000 6,00,000 FA
GR
1,60,000
40,000 Net CA ( Bal. fig.)
P & L a/c*
42,000 ----Investments**
Deb.
6,00,000 ----P & L a/c
Deb. Premium
1.20,000 ----Total
19,72,000 6,40,000 Total
*P & L 31.3.04
Preli. Exp.
Profit for 2 years
Transfer to reserve
Div.
Loss of subsidiary
Writing off investments
80,000
-20,000
3,60,000
-40,000
-2,10,000
- 80,000
- 48,000
WAR
5,50,000
8,30,000
5,92,000
-------
PEACE
1,60,000
2.90,000
-----1,90,000
19,92,000
6,40,000
62,000
**Cost of investments
Writing off of investments
Share in the post acquisition Loss of subsidiary
7,20,000
- 48,000
-80,000
5,92,000
Cap. Profit
40,000
-80000
-10000
-50,000
Rev. Profit
----1,00,000
-----1,00,000
7,20,000
-(-50000 x 0.80)
- 4,80,000
2,80,000
- 48,000 2,32,000
90,000
268
Consolidated B/S of War Ltd and its subsidiary Peace Ltd. as on 31.3.06
Liabilities
Amount
Assets
Amount
ESC
10,50,000
Goodwill
2,32,000
GR
1,60,000
FA
7,10,000
P&L
42,000
Net CA
11,20,000
Deb.
6,00,000
Deb. Premium
1,20,000
M Int.
90,000
Total
20,62,000
Total
20,62,000
Working note to Q. No. 17 :
Capital Profit
15,000
49,000 x (3/12)
- 3500
---23,750
19,000
4,750
P & L b/d
P & L current
Pref. div. paid
Pref. div. proposed
Holding co.s share
Minoritys share
Revenue Profit
-----49,000 x (9/12)
-3500
-7000
26,250
21,000
5,250
Liabilities
S. Capital
R&S
2,05,000
Loss ( fire )
- 5,000
Profit on goods
resold
+30000
Debentures int. 9,750
Deb.
Creditors 80,000+60000
Other liabilities
Total
Drs.
Bank
Total
Amount
4,05,000
3,50,000
+90,000
-20,000 4,20,000
2,65,000
1,10,250
269
Solutions to Test Paper V ( Advanced Accounting )
Working notes to Q. No. 22
(i) Mumbai is holding company of Delhi as Mumbai is holding 75% shares of Delhi
directly.
(ii) Mumbai is holding company of Amritsar as Mumbai is holding 75% shares of
Amritsar. Mumbai is holding 50% shares of Amritsar directly , it is holding 25% shares
of Amritsar through its subsidiary Delhi.
(iii) Mumbai is holding company of Kanpur. Mumbai is holding 831/3 % of Kanpur.
Details are as follows: (a) Mumbai holds 50% shares of Kanpur directly
(b) Mumbai holds 25% shares of Kanpur through its subsidiary Delhi
(c) Mumbai holds 81/3 % shares of Kanpur through its subsidiary Amritsar.
Analysis of profit of Kanpur as on 31st Dec. 2000
Capital profit
General reserve
P&L
Total
Mumbais share
Delhis share
Amritsars share
Minoritys share
Answers
Goodwill 6,37,500
6,00,000
60,000
6,60,000
3.30,000
1,65,000
55,000
1,10,000
Revenue profit
( P & L a/c)
-----2,60,000
2,60,000
1,30,000
65,000
21,667
43,333
Revenue
Profit(GR)
4,00,000
----4,00,000
2,00,000
1,00,000
33,333
66,667
270
Let capital profit of A Ltd. = A
As share 1.00
As share 0.80
Minority Interest :
Paid up capital
0.60
Revenue profit
0.20
Capital profit
0.25
Cost of control
Cost of shares
Paid up capital
Capital profit
CR
1.05
3.00
-2.40
-1.00
0.40
Amount
4.80
3.64
1.81
1.05
Total
11.30
* R & S of A
As share in post acquisition profit of B
Bs share in As profit counted twice
Assets
Goodwill **
FA
Stock
Drs.
Bank
Total
4.00
0.80
-1.16
3.64
0.80
-0.40
0.40
Amount
0.40
7.00
0.65
2.39
0.95
11.30
271
Solutions to Test Paper VI ( Advanced Accounting )
Working note to Q.No.29 :
Assumption : The balance in Revenue reserve a/c on 1.4.2003 was nil.
(Alternatively it can be assumed that the balance in Revenue reserve a/c on 1.4.2003 was
Rs. 75,000)
Analysis of profit of SD on 31.3.2004
Capital
profit
(pre1.10.2003)
RR current
37,500
CR b/d
50,000
CR current
1,30,000
P & L b/d
2,75,000
Div. for year
Ended 31.3.03 -2,50,000
25,000
P & L current
1,27,500
Revaluation profit :L&B
4,40,000
Revaluation loss : Furni.
-30,000
Dep. on revaluation :
L&B
Furni.
Total
7,80,000
Holding co.s share
6,24,000
Minoritys share
1,56,000
Revenue
profit (CR)
(1.10.2003 to
31.3.2004)
Revenue
profit (RR)
(1.10.2003 to
31.3.2004)
37,500
Revenue
profit (P&L)
(1.10.2003 to
31.3.2004)
1,30,000
1,27,500
1,30,000
1,04,000
26,000
37,500
30,000
7,500
-11,000
+ 3,000
1,19,500
95.600
23,900
Cost of control :
Cost of shares 16,10,000 ( this amount is net of pre-acquisition dividend recd.)
Paid up value -16,00,000
Capital profit
-6,24,000
Capital reserve 6,14,000
Minority interest : Paid up capital
Profits (1,56,000 + 26,000 + 7,500 + 23900)
4,00,000
2,13,400
6,13,400
272
Answer to Q. No. 27 :
Analysis of profit of S Ltd 31.3.2002(Rs. 000)
Capital profit
(pre- 1.4.2001)
Revenue profit
( P &L)
( 1.4.0131.3.02)
Revenue
profit (GR)
( 1.4.01 31.3.02)
600
90
300
510
510
306
204
900
540
360
90
54
36
Amount
4,000
982
1,421
660
914
204
400
82
1560
10,223
Assets
P&M
F&F
Stock less stock reserve
Drs.
B/R
Cash
Advances
Total
1,305
-180
+306
-10
Amount
4,991
913
1,759
1,383
215
512
450
10,223
1421
273
Working note to Q. No. 30 : Assumption : Pref. shares are cumulative
Analysis of profit of Hockey Ltd 31.3.2005
Capital profit
(pre1.4.2004)
Revenue
profit (GR)
( 1.4.0431.3.05)
Revenue profit
(P&L)
( 1.4.04 31.3.05)
Minoritys share
2,20,000
62,000
5,38,000
-1,00,000
+20,000
-38,000
------38,000
-38,000 x .75
= -28500
2,20,000
-----2,20,000
2,20,000 x .75
=1,65,000
Cost of control :
Cost of shares (3,10,000 +9,50,000 + 8,00,000)
Pre- acquisition dividend*
Paid up ( Equity including bonus + Pref.)
Capital profit
M. Int. : Paid up equity ( including bonus )
Paid up Pref.
Revenue profit
Revenue profit
Capital profit
20,60,000
-70,000
-(16,50,000+142500)
- ( -28,500)
5,50,000
2,37,500
55,000
1,53,750
-9,500
5,58,000
38,000
5,20,000
5,20,000 x 0.75
+38,000 x .375
= 4,04,250
5,20,000 x .25
+38,000 x .625
=1,53,750
2,26,000
9,86,750
* Dividend for 2003-04 on 70,000 equity shares which were acquired on 1.4.2004.
274
Solutions to Test Paper X ( Advanced Accounting )
Answer to Q. No. 47 ( Assumption : Dep. and writing off of lease for income tax
purposes : Rs.20)
P & L statement for year ended 31.3.96
Sales
2,760
Increase in stock
83
Decrease in WIP
-70
2,773
Purchase material 1218-38
1,180
Purchase of Land
73
Wages
111
Sub-contract
854
Dep
15
Writing off of lease
5
Int.
22
Directors salaries
39
O. salaries
18
A. Exp
147
Audit
20
Prov. For DD
49
2,533
Profit before bonus
240
Bonus
-24
PBT
216
Current tax
133
Deferred tax asset
-25
108
PAT
108
Profit b/d
128
Reserve
-11
Dividend
-25
Profit c/d
200
Balance-sheet as on 31.3.96
Sources of funds:
(I) S.capital
R&S
(II) S.Loan
Application of funds :
FA
Dep
384
-184
200
CA
Deferred tax Asset
CL
968
25
-770
223
100
211
112
423
275
CA : Stock 142 + WIP 140 + Drs. 686 = 968
CL : Creditors 463 +O/s Audit fees 20 +BO 105 + Tax 133 + Div 25 + Bonus
payable 24 = 770
Answer to Q. No. 48 Assumptions(i) : Dep. for income tax purposes : Rs.84 (ii) the
company transfers 10% of profits to reserve through the requirement is only 7.50%
P & L statement for the year ended 31.3.1995 ( Rs. 1500)
Sales
1,500
Increase in Stock
30
Purchase
855
Dep
74
Loss on sale of fixed asset
10
Dis. cost
51
AO
240
Factory closure cost
PBT
Tax
PAT
Profit b/d
Total profit
Reserve
Div.
Profit c/d
B/S as on 31.3.1995
1,230
300
30
270
135
135
40
175
-14
-100
61
S.
Capital
500
1,530
75
Loan
610
FA (370-189)
181
Investments
100
CA :
Stock
100
Drs
390
Bank
604
CL & Provisions :
Creditors
40
114
Div.
276
100
275
Tax
329
135
610
Drs. a/c
(i)
Dr. 90000
(iii)
Dr. 60,000
To
Vendors Drs.
(iv)
To
Bank
To Com. a/c
57000
3000
Total
4,60,000
4,60,000
Discount
5,000
3,24,000
c/d
1,31,000
Total
4,60,000
Creditors a/c
277
Cash ( bal. fig.)
2,72,000
c/d
Purchase
3,20,000
Total
3,20,000
48,000
Total
3,20,000
Cash a/c
S. capital
1,62,000
Creditors
Drs.
3,24,000
57,000
Vendor ( Purchase
56,000
V. Drs.
60,000
2,72,000
Consideration)
Total
5,46,000
P. Exp.
10,000
D. fees
12,000
Salaries
48,000
c/d
91,000
Total
5,46,000
30,000
Purchase
3,20,000
GP
1,62,000
Total
5,12,000
Sales
4,60,000
C. Stock
52,000
Total
5,12,000
Post
Salaries
12,000
36,000
GP
D.Fees
12,000
Com.
Discount
1,250
3,750
Dep. Build.
1,000
3,000
250
750
Dep. fur.
Preli. Exp.
10,000
Pre -
Post
40,500
1,21,500
3,000
278
Underwrit. com.
Capital reserve
4,000
26,000
Net profit
Total
55,000
40,500
1,24,500
Total
40,500
1,24,500
Answer to Q. No. 50 :
Assets
Building
Less dep.
Furniture
Less dep.
Stock
80,000
-4,000
10,000
-1,000
Drs.
Amount
76,000
9,000
52,000
1,31,000
Cash
91,000
Total
3,59,000
Books of Pranav
Realization a/c
L&B
35,68,200
Debentures
10,00,000
Goodwill
5,00,000
Creditors
4,36,200
Drs.
3,98,400
B.O.
2,00,000
Stock
7,85,200
Divya (Business
43,00,000
purchased)
P&M
16,43,900
9,59,500
279
Total
68,95,700
Total
68,95,700
S. Members a/c
Unpaid calls
10,000
Realisation a/c
9,59,500
Shares in Divya
40,00,000
Cash
3,00,000
Total
52,69,500
Share capital
50,00,000
P & L a/c
2,69,500
Total
Purchase consideration :
52,69,500
43,00,000
Net Assets :
&B
L
35,68,200
Drs.
3,58,400
Stock
7,85,200
P& M
16,43,900
Deb.
10,00,000
Creditors
-4,36,200
BO
-2,00,000
47,19,500
Capital reserve
2,79,500
Amount
Assets
Amount
280
Share capital 1,90,00,000
Less unpaid call 50,000
P & L a/c
Capital reserve
Debentures
Liabilities for debentures of
Pranav
Creditors
Liabilities for creditors of
Pranav
Total
1,89,50,000
Goodwill
30,00,000
9,88,500
2,79,500
50,00,000
10,00,000
L&B
P&M
Stock
Debtors
8,34,200
4,36,200
B/R
Bank
3,62,100
10,44,200
2,74,88,400
Total
2,74,88,400
1,39,01,200
55,20,700
25,77,800
10,82,400
a/c
a/c
CL
Loan
Yaa
Cap. Res. (Bal. fig.)
Dr. 325
Dr. 800
700
250
140
35
281
S. capital
R&S
Loan funds
Total sources
FA
Less dep
CA
CL
Total
Before
restructure
300
750
250
1,300
1,000
-400
600
2,000
-1300
700
1300
After
restructure
300
800*
315**
1,415
925***
- 160****
765
1,900*****
-1,250******
650
1415
282
Mach. a/c
Dr. 90,000
Stock a/c
Dr. 80,000
Drs a/c
Dr. 1,20,000
Bank a/c
Dr. 90,000
To Crs. a/c
30,000
To ESC
3,00,000
To Securities Premium
90,000
_________________________________________________________________
Journal of Y :
Shares of X a/c Dr. 3,90,000
Crs. a/c
Dr. 30,000
To Goodwill a/c
10,000
To Machine a/c
1,00,000
To Stock a/c
72,000
To Drs. a/c
1,20,000
To Bank a/c
90,000
To P & L a/c
8,000
To Cap. Res. a/c
20,000
B/S of X Ltd. as on 31.12.1991
Liabilities
ESC
Reserve and surplus :
Securities premium 90,000
Other items
60,000
Crs.
Amount
7,00,000
Total
9,20,000
1,50,000
70,000
Assets
Goodwill
Machinery
Amount
70,000
2,40,000
Stock
Drs.
Bank
Preliminary exp.
Total
1,20,000
3,30,000
1,50,000
10,000
9,20,000
Amount
3,00,000
Assets
Investment
Preli. Exp.
Amount
3,90,000
18,000
Total
4,08,000
1,08,000
4,08,000
SHO
200
THAM
100+20
283
Building
Mach.
Other FA
Net CA
Loan
PC
Less receivable as shareholder of
vendor co
Net payable
Issue price
No. of shares to be issued
600
960
100
1040
-900
2000
150+300
600+600
200+50
1252-12+740
-(1000+700)
2300
-800
1,200
20
-575
1,725
20
1200/20 = 60 Lakhs
Dr.
Dr.
300
275
Amount
2,962.50
Loan
4029,50
4,200.00
Total
11,192.00
Assets
Land
Building
Amount
520.00
1,550.00
Machinery
Other FA
Investment
Net CA
Total
3,660.00
750.00
100.00
4,612.00
11,192.00
284
x = 50,000 +1,00,000 + 20,000 + 0.20 y +75,000 +60,000 + 20,000 -40,000
y = 25,000 +50,000 +5,000 + 0.05x +45,000 +68,000 +20000 70,000
Solving the equations, we get, x = 3,16,768
y = 1,58,838
Journal of Hind:
Business purchase a/c
To Liquidator of Major
To Liquidator of Minor
_______
Goodwill a/c
Mach.
a/c
Furniture a/c
Stock
a/c
Drs.
a/c
Bank
a/c
Investment in Major
Investment in Minor
To Crs. a/c
To BP a/c
_____________
Liquidator of Major
To Investment in Major
To ESC
______________
Liquidator of Minor
To Investment in Minor
To ESC
_______________
Dr.
4,75,606
3,16,768
1,58,838
Dr.
75,000
Dr. 1,50,000
Dr.
25,000
Dr. 1,20,000
Dr. 1,28,000
Dr.
40,000
Dr. 3,16,768 X (1/20)
Dr. 1,58,838 X (1 / 5)
1,10,000
4,75,606
Dr.
3,16,768
316768 X (1/20)
3,00,930
Dr. 1,58,838
1,58,838 X (1/5)
1.27,070
Ledger of Major
Realization a/c
Mach.
Furniture
1,00,000
20,000
Crs.
Hind (Business
40,000
3,16,768
purchase)
Investment
25,000
Stock
75,000
Drs.
60,000
Bank
20,000
56,768
Total
3,56,768
Total
3,56,768
285
Hind Ltd.
Realization a/c
Total
3,16,768
3,16,768
Shareholders a/c
316768x(1/20)
Shares of Hind
3,00,930
Total
3,16,768
Shareholders a/c
Hind Ltd
316768x(1/20)
Esc
Shares of Hind
3,00,930
P & L A/C
60,000
56,768
Total
3,16,768
2,00,000
TOTAL
3,16,768
14,00,000
30,00,000
16,00,000
2,00,000 (Rs.20 per share)
14,00,000 (Rs.70 per share)
(ii) Equity shareholders may be issued 20,000 equity shares of Rs. 30 each and
Preference shareholders 10,000 7% Preference shareholders of Rs. 80 each.
(iii) A new company may be formed with authorised capital of 25,000 equity shares of Rs.
30 each and 12,500 preference shares of Rs. 80 each.
(iv) Current ratio = 2 = [(Drs. + Cash + stock)] / [(Creditors + BO)]
2 = [400000 +150000 +300000] /[350000 + BO]
BO = 75,000 . The remaining amount of BO should be converted into loan.
286
Amount
Assets
FA
Amount
15,00,000
Stock
3,00,000
Drs.
Cash
4,00,000
1,50,000
Total
23,50,000
7,50,000
10,00,000
6,00,000
8,00,000
14,00,000
3,00,000
2,25,000
3,50,000
75,000
23,50,000
(Internal reconstruction)
40,000
L&B
3,00,000
Stock
40,000
PSC
1,00,000
20,000
Deb.
1,00,000
8,20,000
ESC
4,50,000
Total
9,50,000
formalities)
P&L
Capital Reserve ( Bal.
30,000
fig.)
Total
9,50,000
Amount
2,50,000
1,00,000
30,000
Assets
L&B
P&M
Stock
Amount
4,00,000
2,00,000
1,60,000
287
Deb.
Crs.
O/s Exp.
Total
2,00,000
3,20,000
40,000
9,40,000
Drs
Bank
1,60,000
20,000
Total
9,40,000
EXTERNAL RECONSTRUCTION
PC : E. SHARES
60,000 X 2.50
P. Shares
2,000 X 50
2,50,000
Amount
2,50,000
1,00,000
Assets
L&B
P&M
Amount
4,00,000
2,00,000
288
CR
Deb.
Crs.
O/s Exp.
Total
50,000
2,00,000
3,20,000
40,000
9,60,000
Stock
Drs
Bank
Formation exp.
Total
1,60,000
1,60,000
20,000
20,000
9,60,000
Vendors books
Realization a/c
L&B
1,00,000
Deb.
3,00,000
P&M
2,00,000
Crs.
4,00,000
Stock
2,00,000
Exp. Crs.
Drs.
2,00,000
50,000
2,50,000
purchased )
Cash
Shareholders a/c (profit
30,000
2,70,000
on Realization)
Total
10,00,000
Total
10,00,000
Shareholders a/c
P&L
8,20,000
ESC
6,00,000
E shares of A ( New)
1,50,000
PSC
2,00,000
P shares of A ( New)
1,00,000
Realization a/c
2,70,000
Total
10,70,000
Total
10,70,000
Answer to Q No. 60
Journal
Item (i)
11% PSC
To 13% Deb.
To Premium on Deb.
To Bank
a/c
a/c
a/c
a/c
Dr. 4,00,000
Item (ii)
Cap. Reduction
a/c
Dr. 1.32.000
3,63,600
36,360
40
289
To ESC
a/c
(Note : After this entry , there will be 10640 E shares of Rs. 100 each, Rs. 50 paid up)
Item (iii)
ESC
a/c
Dr. 2,66,000
To Cap. Reduction
a/c
(Note : After this entry , there will be 10640 E shares of Rs. 100 each, Rs. 25 paid up)
Item (iv)
ESC
a/c
Dr. 2,66,000
To Rs.50 ESC a/c
(Note : After this entry , there will be 10640 E shares of Rs. 50 each, Rs. 25 paid up)
Share call
a/c
Dr. 2,66,000
To Rs.50 ESC
a/c
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------Bank
a/c
Dr. 2,66,000
To Share call a/c
(Note : After this entry , there will be 10640 E shares of Rs. 50 each, fully paid up)
Items (v), (vi) and (vii)
Capital reduction
a/c
Dr.
1,57,750
To Goodwill
a/c
40,000
To Investments
a/c
25,000
To FA
a/c
80,000
To Provision for discount on Drs a/c
12,750
------Stock
a/c
Dr.
21,000
To Cap. Reduction a/c
_______________________________________________________________________
G. Reserve
a/c
Dr.
2,750
To Capital reduction a/c
(Being the debit balance of capital reduction a/c written off against General Reserve) -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------Increase in working capital ( 1.4.92 to 30.9.92) :
Bank 55,100 + Drs.40,000 - Crs. 26,000 Stock 8,000 = 61,100.
Increase in WC is on a/c of Profit before Dep and interest
Profit = 61,100 Dep interest = 61,100 25,000 23,634 = 12,466
Cash and Bank summary ( 1.4.92 30.9.92)
b/d
1,00,000
PSC
40
290
S. Call
2,66,000
Increase on a/c of
55,100
Interest
23,634
Deb.
1,81,800
c/d
2,15,626
Total
4,21,100
operation
Total
4,21,100
Amount
5,32,000
40,000
57,250
36.360
12,466
1.81,800
3,36,000
11,95,876
Assets
FA
CA:
Stock
Drs(net)
Bank
Amount
4,75,000
2,23,000
2,82,250
2,15,626
Total
11,95,876
Answer to Q No. 61
Journal of A Ltd
Item (i)
8 % PSC
To Rs. 7.50 PSC
To Capital reduction
----------------ESC
To Rs. 2 ESC
To Rs. capital reduction
----------------Rs. 7.50 PSC
To Rs. 10 PSC
-----------------Rs 2 ESC
To Rs. 10 ESC a/c
----------------
7,20,876
a/c
a/c
a/c
Dr. 2,00,000
a/c
a/c
a/c
Dr. 1,50,000
a/c
a/c
Dr. 1,50,000
a/c
Dr.
1,50,000
50,000
30,000
1,20,000
30,000
291
Item (ii)
Capital reduction
a/c
Dr 16000
To Rs. 10 ESC
a/c
----------------Item(iii)
Share premium
a/c
Dr. 5,000
To capital reduction a/c
-----------------Item (iv)
Cash
a/c
Dr. 12,300
9 % Deb.
a/c
Dr. 60,000
Acc. Int.
a/c
Dr. 2,700
To Freehold
a/c
60000
To Cap. Reduction
a/c
15,000
----------------Item (v)
Capital reduction
a/c
Dr. 20,000
To P & M
a/c
20,000
----------------------Item (vi)
Cash
a/c
Dr. 32,000
Capital reduction
a/c
Dr. 8,000
To Investment a/c
a/c
------------Item (vii)
Capital reduction
a/c
Dr. 76,100
To Goodwill
a/c
55,000
To Preli. Exp.
a/c
2,500
To Stock
a/c
8,600
To Drs.
a/c
10,000
------------Item (viii)
Insurance co.
a/c
Dr. 6,300
Capital reduction
a/c
Dr. 700
To Cash
a/c
-----------Cash
a/c
Dr. 6,300
To Insurance co.
----------------Item (ix)
BO
a/c
Dr. 43.600
To cash a/c
__________________________________________
Capital reduction a/c
a/c
Dr. 69,200
To P & L a/c
69,200
292
----------------------( After posting of all these entries, the balance in the capital reduction a/c will be nil)
B/S of A Ltd ( and reduced ) as on 31.3.1992
Liabilities
ESC
PSC
Crs
BO
Total
Amount
1,50,000
46,000
85,000
52,400
3,33,400
Assets
Lease-hold
P&M
Stock
Drs.
Total
Amount
1,22,000
1.40,000
20,000
51,400
3,33,400
Hamer
9,00,000
-1,00,000
-1,00,000
7,00,000
Av. Profit
Non-trade Income
Future Maintainable profit
Normal profit
Super Profit
Goodwill
Purchase consideration :
Goodwill
FA
Investment
Stock
Drs
Cash
Crs.
PC
No. of shares of X Ltd.
Hamer
1,35,000
-6,000
1,29,000
-700000 x 0.15
24000
96000
H
96,000
4,00,000
1,00,000
2,04,000
1,70,000
30,000
-100000
9,00,000
90,000
Grace
3,00,000
-50,000
2,50,000
Grace
47,000
--------47,000
- 250000 x 0.15
95000
38000
G
38,000
1,00,000
----1,42,000
60,000
10,000
-50000
3,00,000
30,000
293
B/S of X Ltd as on 1.1.82
Liabilities
ESC
Crs.
Amount
12,00,000
1,50,000
Total
13,50,000
Assets
Goodwill
FA
Investments
Stock
Drs.
Cash
Total
Amount
1,34,000
5,00,000
1,00,000
3,46,000
2,30,000
40,000
13,50,000
Tangible FA
CA
Deb. And Crs.
Closing CE
X
10,00,000
3,50,000
-4,00,000
9,50,000
Y
5,00,000
1,40,000
-1,50,000
4,90,000
Z
6,00,000
80,000
-2,00,000
4,80,000
X
1,60,000
- 20,000
1,40,000
95,000
45,000
135000
Y
1,44,000
+10,000
1,54,000
49,000
105000
315000
Z
68,000
-10,000
58,000
48,000
10,000
30,000
Purchase consideration :
CCE
Goodwill
Total
Shares
(In the ratio of 140 :154:58)
Debentures (bal. figure )
X
9,50,000
1,35,000
10,85,000
Y
4,90,000
3,15,000
8,05,000
Z
4,80,000
30,000
5.10,000
Total
7,15,900
7,87,500
2,96,600
18,00,000*
24,00,000
294
3,69,100
10,85,000
17,500
8,05,000
2,13,400
5,10,000
6,00,000
24,00,000
*Issue of Equity shares and Debentures for this purpose is to be in the ratio of 3:1. ( item
no. 6 of the question)
Answer to Q. No. 64 (b) :
B/S of XYZ as on 31.3.87
Liabilities
S. Capital
Deb.
Crs.
Amount
21,50,000
6,00,000
4,50,000
Total
32,00,000
Answer to Q. No. 65 :
Assets
Goodwill
FA
CA
P.exp.
Total
Amount
4,80,000
21,00,000
5,70,000
50,000
32,00,000
Goodwill
FA
WC
Loan
P . Shares
Net assets for equity shareholders
Big
40
200
200
-100
--------340
Small
75
429
200
-100
-60
544
Intrinsic value of share of purchasing co. ( Small) : 544 crores/ 4 crore = 136
Net assets taken over : Rs. 340 Crores.
PC = 340 crores/136 = 2.50 crores shares of Rs. 10 each i.e. Rs. 25 Crores
Journal of Small :
BP
a/c
Dr. 25
To Liquidator of Big
25
-------------------Liquidator of Big
Dr. 25
To ESC
25
------------FA
a/c
Dr. 150
CA
a/c
Dr. 200
To Loan
100
To ESC
a/c
25
To CR
a/c
225 ( Bal. fig.)
------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------B/S of Small Ltd as on 31.3.88 (Rs. Crores)
295
Liabilities
ESC
PSC
R & S 150 + 225 ( CR)
Loan
Total
Amount
65
60
375
200
Assets
FA
CA
Amount
300
400
Total
700
A = 9,72,222
M = 6,88,889
Journal Of AM
Business Purchase a/c
To Liquidator of AB
To Liquidator of MB
--------FA
a/c
CA
a/c
Shares of AB
a/c
Shares of MB
a/c
To Liabilities For Deb.
To Crs.
To B P a/c
----------Liq. Of AB
To Shares of AB
To ESC
To Cash a/c
------------
Dr. 16,61,111
9,72,222
6,88,889
Dr. 10,00,000
Dr. 5,00,000
Dr 9,72,222(2/5)
Dr. 6,88,889(1/4)
3,20,000
80,000
16,61,111
Dr. 9,72,222
9,72,222(2/5)
5,83,300
33
296
Liq. Of MB
Dr. 6,88,889
To Shares of MB
6,88,889(1/4)
To ESC
5,16,600
To Cash a/c
67
-------Liability for Deb.
a/c
Dr. 3,20,000
To 15% Debentures a/c
3,20,000
---------------Amalgamation Adj. a/c
Dr. 70000
To Investment Allowance Reserve 70000
------------------------------------
LOGARITHMS
Logarithms are of great use in calculations. They simplify typical
calculations. With the help of Logarithms, we can make such calculations which
other wise are difficult to make. Logarithms are of two types (i) simple Logarithms
( mathematically called as log base to 10 ) (ii) natural log ( mathematically called
as natural log ). In this note we shall be studying simple logarithms.
The logarithm of a number consists of two parts characteristic and
mantissa. Characteristic is determined without any table. Mantissa is determined
using log tables.
Finding characteristic of a number 1 or greater than 1 : In this case characteristic
is equal to number of digits before decimal minus one.
Number
56
567
5678
56432
Character-
5670.23 167.89
3
istic
Finding characteristic of a number less than one : In this case characteristic is
negative. Negative sign is written in the form of bar . For example -1 is written as
1 , -2 is written as 2 , -3 is written as 3 . Write the number ( of which
297
characteristic is to be determined ) in proper decimal form . In this case
characteristic is number of zeros before and just after decimal .
Number
.9
.08
.007
.0006
.00006
.00908
.002003
Number in
0.9
0.08
0.007
0.0006
proper
Decimal form
Characteristic
233
2655
456.8
Characteristic
Mantissa
.3674
.4240
.6598
Logarithms
2.3674
3.4240
2.6598
0.89
0.00902
.9494
.9552
ANTILOG is determined using Antilog tables. The table is consulted only for
Mantissa part. Place of decimal is characteristic plus one. This place is counted
from left hand side.
Number
233
2655
456.8
Log
2.3674
3.4240
2.6598
0.89
0.00902
Antilog
Question 1 : Find log of (i) 2 (ii) 56 (iii) 567 (iv) 5678 (v) 56.78 (vi) 0.543 (vii)
55556.67
298
Question 2 : Find Antilog of above log values.
299
300
301
302
CONTENTS
PAGE
Value Added Statement
EVA
19
24
29
31
36
Mutual Funds
41
Merchant Bankers
46
48
NBFC
50
62
65
ESOP
70
ESPP
72
Corporate Governance
73
77
121
143
Restructuring )
Test Papers
174
225
LOGARITHMS
264
303
304